Reaction Mechanisms and Control Properties of Phosphotransferases: Internationales symposium Reinhardsbrunn Mai 1971 [Reprint 2021 ed.] 9783112575024, 9783112575017

154 53 121MB

English Pages 710 [696] Year 1974

Report DMCA / Copyright

DOWNLOAD FILE

Polecaj historie

Reaction Mechanisms and Control Properties of Phosphotransferases: Internationales symposium Reinhardsbrunn Mai 1971 [Reprint 2021 ed.]
 9783112575024, 9783112575017

Citation preview

REACTION MECHANISMS AND CONTROL PROPERTIES OF PHOSPHOTRANSFERASES

Internationales Symposium Reinhardsbrunn Mai 1971

AKADEMIE-VERLAG 1973

BERLIN

Honorary President: Prof. Dr. Dr. Drs. h. c. Karl Lohmann Präsident der Deutschen Gesellschaft f ü r experimentelle Medizin Chairmen: Academician Prof. Dr. S. E . Severin President of the All-Union Biochemical Society of USSR Prof. Dr. E. Hofmann Vorsitzender der Biochemischen Gesellschaft der D D R Scientific Secretary: H.-J. Böhme

Erschienen im Akademie-Verlag GmbH, 108 Berlin, Leipziger Str. 3—4 Copyright 1973 by Akademie Verlag GmbH • Lizenznummer: 202 • 100/541/73 Offsetdruck: VEB Druckerei „Thomas Müntzer", 582 Bad Langensalza Bestellnummer 5996 . ES 18 G 1 • EDV: 761 706 7 Printed in the German Democratic Republic 68,-

WELCOME ADDRESS by E. HOFMANN, Leipzig

Dear and distinguished participants of the first joint symposium of the AllunionBiochemical Society of USSR and the Biochemical Society of GDR! It is a very great honour and privilege for me to welcome you in our country, in the German Democratic Republic, especially in this pleasant place here in Thuringia. I greet you on behalf of the committee and the members of the Biochemical Society of GDR. In the first place I greet cordially our friends and colleagues from USSR, particularly the President of the Allunion-Biochemical Society of USSR, Professor SEVERIN from Moscow. Owing to his great activity in all stages of organization the first joint symposium of the Biochemical Societies of USSR and GDR actually could take place. We welcome all members of the delegation of USSR. We hope indeed that all of you will have enjoyable and interesting days in our German Democratic Republic, a country which is tightly connected with the Soviet-Union in political, scientific and economical relations and in the struggle for peace which is essential for the success of all efforts of people all over the world. We a r e very satisfied and glad about your participation and we a r e sure that this metting will improve our friendship and contribute to a still closer collaboration of biochemists between our two countries. We a r e happy to greet distinguished and world-famous scientists from others countries too, who followed our invitation to participate and to give lectures about their experimental and theoretical work, in fields which a r e closely connected with the topics of this meeting. It is an honour for me to welcome outstanding scientists from the other socialistic countries like Czechoslowakia and Hungary. We greet cordially our friends and colleagues from the German Federal Republic, most of them a r e not for the first time in GDR, and all of them belong to the large group of people who a r e welcome in our country everytime. Last not least we are deeply impressed that also international wellknown scientists from the other westeuropean countries followed our invitation. We cordially greet

VI our friends and guests from The Netherlands, Belgium, France, Spain, Denmark and Austria. We hope that all of you will have in this week interesting and enjoyable days, filled with stimulating discussions. In addition, we are convinced that this lovely place and its surroundings will encourage us to improve our personal contacts during the days and the evenings. The subject of this symposium covers a large field, the enzymatic transfer of phosphate- and phosphoryl-groups, but also the transfer of other phosphorouscontaining residues like pyrophosphate and nucleotides, especially having in mind the polymerases catalyzing the synthesis of nucleic acids. In addition we are able to discuss also the role of pyridoxalphosphate in phosphorylase and in other enzymes. A round-table-conversation will be devoted to the interactions of subunits in proteins and in general to protein-protein-interactions. Especially association-dissociation-reactions of proteins should be discussed. We are convinced that the wellknown high standard of the scientists giving lectures and the selected audience will be the best guarantee for a successfull symposium, and we hope indeed that we have organized the programme in such a way that all participants will realize this for themselves. Our knowledge about metabolic transfer-reactions started with the splendid discoveries in MEYERHOFs laboratory, performed by Professor KARL LOHMANN, which are concerned with phosphate transfer reactions. It was KARL LOHMANN, the honorary president of our meeting, and discoverer of ATP who first described the reversible phosphate transfer from ATP to creatine in muscle catalyzed by creatine phosphokinase, a reaction today still called as LOHMANN reaction. The famous and pioneering contributions of biochemists from Soviet-Union in the field of transfer reactionsarewell known to the international scientific community. BRAUNSTEIN and KRITSMAN discovered 1937 the transfer of amino groups between amino and ketoacids. ENGELHARDT founded the concept of respiratory chain phosphorylation working with avian erythrocytes and BELITZER and TSIBAKOWA discovered independently from KALCKAR 1939 the formation of ATP in the respiratory chain. Another most important disclosure from this time is the discovery of the ATPase nature of myosin and the development of Mechanobiochemistry by ENGELHARDT. Especially in this field the combined endeavours of sovietic, hungarian and german workers in the classical era of biochemistry should be mentioned. So we see, that the subject of this symposium is not an accident, but it has its roots in the brilliant history of biochemistry in our countries.

vn Now, ladies and gentlemen, permit me to tell you something about this place and this region. The history of Thuringia a s one of the central parts of Germany is very eventful. It consisted until the revolution in 1918 of not less than nearly ten minor states, especially small counties and duchies. Reinhardsbrunn castle belonged to the dukedom of Saxonia-Coburg-Gotha. For the dukes it served a s Summer residence and hunting castle. In the early middleage here in Reinhardsbrunn existed a Benedictine monastery of the house of LUDÖWINGER. It has been destroyed completely during the 30 year war. The thuringian country, especially Erfurt, the Wartburg, Weimar and Jena played an important role in German literature and culture. Erfurt had an old university founded 1392, that is 17 years before the Leipzig university has been founded, however the Erfurt university has been closed in 1816 under the influence and the force of the foreign rule of Napoleon. In the Erfurt university MARTIN LUTHER studied. In the 16**1 century this university was one of the most important central places of German Humanism. Today Erfurt is the capital of this district, it has a Medical Academy and a Pedagogical High School. Gothic cathedrals and small old houses, narrow streets and pithoresque sceneries in the city remember the visitor to the old history of this town. Not far from here is the Wartburg, wellknown from "Sängerkrieg" ("struggle of minstrels") and from the famous opera "Tannhäuser" by RICHARD WAGNER. This castle served a s hiding-place of MARTIN LUTHER, the great german reformator and humanist. In this castle MARTIN LUTHER translated the Bible in the 1520 ietl1 and layed the most important fundaments for the development of the german literary language. In the other direction from here we come to Weimar, the town of german classical literature and culture, where GOETHE and SCHILLER, as well a s WIELAND and HERDER lived. Later on, world famous composers worked in Weimar, like FRANZ LISZT and RICHARD STRAUSS. Until today Weimar respires the air of this famous tradition. On Wednesday, you can visit the abundant and splendid houses of JOHANN WOLFGANG von GOETHE and the more humble home of FRIEDRICH SCHILLER. In preparation of this introductory lecture I read again the inaugural lecture of FRIEDRICH SCHILLER a s unsalaried professor of history at the university of Jena, now called Friedrich-Schiller-University: 'Was heißt und zu welchem

vm Ende studiert man Universalgeschichte?" (Translated: "What means and to which intention people study universal history? "). In this lecutre, which did not lose its significance also for our time of its high technical standard and its rapid growth of knowledge, SCHILLER divided scholars into two groups, the philosophical, intellectual ones and the socalled, by SCHILLER called "Brotgelehrter", translated perhaps as "scholar only living for his earning". He pointed out that for the last type of scholars each progress in science causes annoyance and despair, because his wellformed and in his view socalled scientific system goes to rack and ruin als knowledge proceeds. He is too lazy and any effort would be terrible for him to complete his knowledge and to support progress. Opposite to him is the intellectual and philosophical minded scholar, the true scientist, who is satisfied and happy about each progress in science and society and who supports all movements towards a deeper insight into nature, history, society and the regularities of their development. No doubt, to which group of people FRIEDRICH SCHILLER, one of the greatest dramatists of all times and freeman of the French revolution belonged! GOETHE, complete different in his individuality and character in comparison to his friend FRIEDRICH SCHILLER composed most of his beautiful poems in the lovely country of the Thuringian forests like "Über allen Wipfeln ist Ruh", "Erlkönig", "Ilmenau" and others. In contrast to this classical and cultural tradition of this district, we have to remember ourselves on another aspect of history. Not far from Weimar, on the Ettersberg, we found now a National Memorial reminding us of the blackest chapter of german history. On this mountain, 10 km from the town of GOETHE and SCHILLER, during the time of Nazism one of the most awful concentration camps, that of Buchenwald, was erected. In this camp nearly 60 000 prisoners were assassinated, among them the leaders of the german working class, the communist ERNST THÄLMANN and the social democrat RUDOLF BREITSCHEID. Both, Weimar and Buchenwald, are National Memorial Places for our people and also for foreign visitors remembering both on great cultural and scientific efforts and also on the most evil antihumanism in history. In GDR social liefe and prosperity, development of science, public health service and industry have made great achievements, predominantly in the last 10 years. Now, ladies and gentlemen, I am going to open this symposium, hoping that all

IX of us will have high scientific profit. Now, I will ask Professor SEVERIN to act as chairman in this first section in the morning.

CONTENTS

1.

ENZYMATIC HYDROLYSIS OF INORGANIC PHOSPHATES S. M. AVAEVA Hydrolysis of the substrates by inorganic pyrophosphatase from yeast

3

V. HAHN On the origin of inorganic pyrophosphatase obtained from bakers' yeast

17

G. HANSEN Dissociation and association behavior of inorganic pyrophosphatase from bakers' yeast P. HEITMANN On the state of aromatic amino acids in inorganic pyrophosphatase from bakers' yeast I.S. KULAEV Phosphotransferase reactions in the inorganic polyphosphate metabolism M.S. KRITSKY The study of polyphosphate depolymerase of Neurospora crassa T. P. AFANASIEVA

21

27 35

.

49

Some properties of a polyphosphatase from Endomyces magnusii

57

G.I. Some KDNOSHENKO properties of polyphosphatase from Neurospora crassa . . I. A. KRASHENINNIKDV Localization of polyphosphates and polyphosphatases in Neurospora crassa S. E. MANSUROVA On a possibility of non-enzymatic transphosphorylation by highpolymeric polyphosphate M. A. NESMEYANOVA On the regulation of some enzymes of phosphorous metabolism in E. coli F. JUNGNICKEL Significance of repressible polyphosphate phosphohydrolases in yeast and higher plants

65

81 87

xn 2.

ADENOSINETRIPHOSPHATASES A.D. VINOGRADOV Some properties of the soluble mitochondrial ATPase YU.N. LEIKYN The identification of ionic form of phosphate accompanying active Ca^ + uptake in rat liver mitochondria V.l. DESHCHEREVSKY Mechanism of activation of myosin adenosinetriphosphatase by actin A.A. BOLDYREV Transfer ATPase of muscle membranes . . . N.S. PANTELEJEVA 0"-exchange reaction a s a test in the studing of the phosphoryl groups transport from ATP to myosin N. P. MESHKOVA Phosphorylated derivates of histidine containing dipeptides, their synthesis and physiological role

95 113 121 125 131 137

S.L. BONTING Na-K activated ATPase and active cation transport

143

S.L. BONTING Anion effects on Mg-activated ATPase of Lizard gastric mucosa

167

S. L. BONTING Inorganic pyrophosphatase in developing teeth: effects of Magnesium and diphosphonates K.R.H. REPKE Does Na + + K + - dependent ATPase consist of more than one enzyme entity?

179

J. G. NORBY Binding of ATP to (Na + K ) activated ATPase. Number of binding sites and enzyme-ATP dissociation constant

199

M.S. KRASAVINA Some properties of ATPase from plant tissues

205

D. DEITMER + The interaction of monosaccharides with intestinal (Na - K ) ATPase

213

F . MÜLLER Monosaccharide dependent Na -flaxes across intestinal epithelium and their possible relations to (Na+ - K+) -ATPase

221

xm 3.

MECHANISM OF ACTION AND CONTROL PROPERTIES OF SELECTED ENZYME SYSTEMS IN MAIN ROUTES OF METABOLISM General Problems H. HOLZER Regulation of enzymes by phosphorylation and adenylylation . . . . A. SOLS Allosteric effects by products and substrates involving specifically regulatory sites T. KfiLETI Regulation of enzymic activity by intra - and inter-subunit interactions

231 239 253

Selected Enzymes E. HELMREICH The function of pyridoxal-5' -phosphate in glycogen Phosphorylase . D. PALM Conformational changes upon binding of PLP, PLP-analogues and 5' -AMP to the apoenzyme of rabbit skeletal muscle Phosphorylase b N.B. LIVANOVA About allosteric interactions on Phosphorylase b from muscle . . . H. WILL Allosterische Eigenschaften der Glykogenphosphorylase b aus Herzund Skelettmuskel des Schweins - eines gemischten V, K-Enzym systems E.G. KRAUSE Isoenzyme der Phosphorylase b im Herzmuskel des Schweines: einige Aspekte zur Regulation der Glykogenolyse J. RICARD Structure and catalytic mechanisms of some hexokinases S.V. SO KD LOVA Lokalisierung und Eigenschaften der Hexokinase pflanzlicher Gewebe E. HOFMANN Unsolved problems of phosphofructokinase H.W. HOFER Relations between structure and catalytic activity of rabbit muscle phosphofructokinase E.G. AFTING Interconversion of two forms of yeast phosphofructokinase . . . . St. LIEBE Influence of effectors on the molecular properties and enzymic activity of yeast phosphofructokinase G.F. DOMAGK Isolation and characterization of fructose diphosphate aldolase from beef muscle

273 297 307

315 323 331 353 361 367 385 393

XIV

G. ZIMMERMANN Studies on subunit structure of erythrocyte phosphofructokinase . . B. KUHN Significance of the PFK-reaction for the regulation of glycolysis . . C. GANCEDO Regulation of fructose-1, 6-diphosphatase in yeasts, inactivation by glucose K. BRAND Mechanisms of enzymatic aldol cleavage of fructose-6-phosphate.

421 433

.

J. OVADI Interaction and dissimilarity of subunits of glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase D. MARETZH Kinetic properties of glyceraldehyde-phosphate dehydrogenase from erythrocytes B. HESS Structure and function of pyruvate kinase H. -J. WIEKER pH-function and allosteric control of yeast pyruvate kinase . . . . V. HULE The alterations of isoenzymogram of lactatdehydrogenase in rabbits by synthetic estrogen

4.

415

449

473 479 4 85 505

513

ENZYMATIC SYNTHESIS AND SPLITTING OF RIBONUCLEIC ACID E. K.F. BAUTZ Positive Control of RNA synthesis W. ZILLIG Structure, function and modification of the DNA-dependent RNApolymerase from E. coli K. SEBESTA DNA-dependent RNA polymerase: properties of the ribonucleoside triphosphates binding sites a s revealed by inhibition studies with substrate analogues

519 527

531

K. HORSKA DNA-dependent RNA polymerase inhibition by L-ATP J. SIMUTH The study of substrate specifity of polynucleotide phosphorylase (Streptomyces aureofaciens)

541

A. HOLY The use of modified nucleotide derivates for the study of some nucleolytic enzymes

553

537

XV

5.

H. w r r z E L Catalytic principles used in the reaction of RNase A, T . and T„ with substrates

567

E. ZELINKOVA The specific ribonuclease from Streptomyces aureofaciens . . . .

585

S.I. BEZBORODOVA Some properties of extracellular RNases of fungi

591

SPECIAL TOPICS R. WOHLHUETER Thermodynamics of the adenylylation of glutamine synthetase . . .

603

S.N. LYSLOVA Temperature dependence of creatine kinase activity

611

K.B. SEREBROVSKAJA The behavior of t r a n s f e r a s e s in heterogenic lipid-water systems . .

617

J . G . REICH A general computer strategy for the analysis of kinetic and binding curves A. HORN Kinetic investigations of enzymes with substrates forming metal complexes

629

G. Gerber Interaction of imidazole with multivalent anions a s model for binding of phosphocompounds to proteins

631

L. POLGAR Enhanced reactivity of the SH-group of thiol-subtilisin

639

E. GRUNDIG Ursprung und Eigenschaften von Isozymen der Phosphomonoesterasen

645

J. BEHLKE Ligandinduzierte Änderungen von CD-Spektren und vom AssoziationsDissoziations-Gleichgewicht des Neunaugen-Hämoglobins . . . .

661

R. KLEINE properties of a high molecular aryl-amidase-phosphatase-complex from rat kidney microsomes and attempts for the separation of both enzyme activities

673

625

I. ENZYMATIC HYDROLYSIS OF INORGANIC PHOSPHATES

Laboratory of Bioorganic Chemistry, Lomonosov State University, Moscow

S.M. AVAEVA, T.I. NAZAROVA HYDROLYSIS OF THE SUBSTRATES BY INORGANIC PYROPHOSPHATASE FROM YEAST

A considerable body of evidences has been accumulated by enzymology which show that general conclusions and prognostications a r e possible a s far a s certain groups of enzymes are concerned. It would be valuable to discuss properties of the large group of enzymes r e sponsible for various pyrophosphates metabolism just from this point of view. According to the modern classification these enzymes belong to three classes comprising about 200 enzymes: hydrolases, transferases and ligases. The enzymes of the first class which hydrolyse polyphosphate bonds include numerous ATP-ases and pyrophosphatases. Transferases utilize ATP or some other N T P ' s a s one of the substrates, the cleavage of polyphosphate bond being accompanied by t r a n s fer of the phosphoric or pyrophosphoric residue to an acceptor. A great number of enzymes belongs to the ligase class. They participate in the synthesis of the C-O, C-S, C-N and C-C bonds and their action is conjugated with degradation of ATP. All the above enzymes are functionally different, but the fact of their utilizing the same compound as one of the substrates, certainly, makes them similar in some ways. Indeed, all the enzymes mentioned require high metal ion concentrations for their activity to be revealed. Uncomplexed polyphosphate, appearing in the reaction mixture at low concentrations of metal ions, inhibits the enzyme. When concentration of metal exceeds that of polyphosphate the rate of enzymatic reaction also may decrease. These data could be interpreted to mean that the formation of the active complex of these enzymes proceeds via a similar mechanism. It is also essential that whatever the mechanism of the ATP-enzyme interactions (ping-pong, ordered or random sequential mechanisms), - in any case the enzyme should have a locus for ATP binding and a similar structure of certain part of the active centre. There are some aspects pertaining to the

4

problem of possible similarity of the active sites of the enzymes digesting the same substrate. When one is dealing with the chemical nature of amino acids forming a protein molecule the possibility of synthesis of an innumerable number of proteins comes into mind. However, the number of amino acids, which are present in the active centre and take part in the chemical conversions of the substrate, is relatively small. If one takes into account the pH optimum of the enzyme and the pK's of the functional groups of the protein, this set of amino acids is further reduced. Thus, it may be concluded that the enzymatic conversion of polyphosphates involve just a small number of functional groups of proteins the groups being the same in many enzymes. Present day enzymology possesses rather scanty knowledge about the primary structure and the mechanism of action of these enzymes. But since these enzymes are believed to have more or less similar mechanism of action, the understanding of the mechanism of any enzyme of the group may be useful for elucidating the mechanisms of the others. The present paper describes the results of our study of yeast inorganic pyrophosphatase. Pyrophosphatase activity in yeast was discovered long ago, and by 1952 KUNITZ (1) had described the methods of isolation, purification and crystallization of the enzyme. Inorganic pyrophosphatase from yeast is a protein of the albumin type with a molecular weight about 60, 000 (2). Two main questions - the quaternary structure and the mechanism of action of this enzyme will be discussed below. Manifestation of enzymatic activity is undoubtedly associated with the quaternary structure of the molecule. Our first experiments with sodium dodecyl sulphate resulted in the suggestion that the molecule of yeast inorganic pyrophosphatase dissociates into subunits (3). Most important data on the enzyme quaternary structure were obtained when the protein was treated with maleic anhydride. The protein molecule undergoes noticeable changes even when there are only 9-10 maleic acid residues per molecule of the protein (4). Determination of molecular weight of such "partially" acylated protein and that of completely acylated one showed that the molecule of inorganic pyrophosphatase from yeast consists of four subunits (Table 1). Dissociation into dimers takes place after acylation of some part of e -amino groups, while dissociation into monomers requires acylation of all lysine residues. The next step was characterization of the subunits. Even the data on the consecutive dissociation of the protein by the action of maleic anhydride gave grounds to believe

5 Table 1 PHYSICO-CHEMICAL CONSTANTS OF YEAST PYROPHOSPHATASE AND ITS SUBUNITS Constants Proteins

Si0

7 2 -1 D x 10 cm • sec

Native (tetramer)

Partially acylated Totally acylated (dim er) (monomer)

4.2(c—o)

1.8(c—•o)

l(c=0. 5%)

6. 68 1

4.6

7.4

56 000

Mz 36 000

Molecular weight: Trotman's method

Mw 30 000 Svedberg's method

60 000

1)

36 000

13 000

30 000

14 000 17 000

Sedimentation equilibrium method disc electrophoresis method 1) H. SCHACHMAN (2)

that the subunit s were not identical. The suggestion of a 2 @2

structure

was

favoured by the study of the action of carboxypeptidase A on pyrophosphatase (5). Four amino acids - leucine, phenylalanine, tyrosine and alanine have been detected after one hour hydrolysis. Other amino acids appeared when the incubation time was increased. However, only two moles of every C-terminal amino acids were found per mole of protein. The o^Pg structure has received a great impetus from the results of the Edman degradation experiments in an automatic Beckman sequencer. It was revealed that after every five steps two amino acids cleave off in equal amounts. Prior to the study of mechanism of the enzyme action we tried to answer the following questions: what a r e the pathways of the active enzyme-substrate complex formation. Whether the enzyme-substrate interaction involves a chemical modification of the enzyme, i. e. formation of the covalent intermediates. What functional groups of the enzyme a r e responsible for these reactions. In the case of yeast inorganic pyrophosphatase the active complex consists of the

6 enzyme, pyrophosphate and metal ion. The most general model describing the first steps of enzymatic reaction is the following

Examination of the velocity dependence upon free Mg

+2

or PP concentrations

while one of them was held constant resulted in the determination of the dissociation constants (Table 2). Table 2 DISSOCIATION CONSTANTS OF THE ENZYME-PYROPHOSPHATE-METAL COMPLEXES (pH 7, 5 mM Tris-HCl buffer, 25°C) Reaction

Symbol Value x 10 4 M

EPP

-

EPPMg

-

EPPMg

EPP + Mg E + PPMg

EMg PPMg

E + PP

E + Mg =5=!=

PP + Mg

K

s K' K

0, 085 ± 0,008 m

sm K m K 0

1, 5

+0,15

0, 025 ± 0, 005 20 5

The data presented enabled to discuss the organization of enzyme-substrate complex. The enzyme-metal complex is very unstable, that is why the formation of the active complex by the way shown in the lower part of the general scheme is hardly probable. Uncomplexed pyrophosphate may bind to the enzyme rather strongly. It accounts for the fact of inhibition of the enzyme by pyrophosphate. As pyrophosphate may bind to the enzyme without metal the latter cannot play the role the bridge between the enzyme and pyrophosphate. The comparisonbetween K ; and K

shows that magnesium pyrophosphate binds to the enzyme more strongly than sm pyrophosphate. On the other hand the metal is bound more tightly in the enzyme-

pyrophosphate complex than in the pyrophosphate one. These facts should be evidently interpreted as favouring the structure given below. Such structure involves the attachment of the metal both to the enzyme and pyrophosphate. Ms PP

Ability of pyrophosphatase to be modified by substrates was elucidated in experiments with a number of labelled compounds: The first compounds were derivatives of serylpyrophosphate (PPSer) with 32 the P atom in the p -position or 14 with the C atom in the serine

32PPSer PPSer( M C) 32 p 32 p 32

p

moiety (6). Both phosphorous atoms were labelled in inorganic pyrophosphate. Reaction with labelled

0

inorganic phosphate.was also studied.

0

NHC0C6H5 PPSer

All these compounds were incubated with the enzyme 5°C. After 10 min. of incubation the at reaction was interrupted and the protein was separated

from the low molecular weight radioactive compounds by passing the mixture through a Sephadex G-75 column (Fig. 1). These experiments revealed some facts which are essential for the understanding of the mechanism of the enzymatic action. Firstly, regardless of the substrate 32 14 part which was labelled, both with the P - and C-substrates labelled protein could be obtained. Secondly, the label incorporates in protein both in the presence and absence of the metal. It points to the fact that at the first step (a) of the enzyme-pyrophosphate interaction the whole substrate molecule is covalently bound. At this step no metal ion is required (7). fa)

E + ROPP

(b) E-PPOR

— E— PPOR Me+

-

E - P + ROP

8 In the presence of metal ions the next step (b), i. e. hydrolysis of the pyrophosphate bond may proceed. Metal ions do cause a change in the quality of the label in the protein (Table 3).

Table 3 LABEL RELEASE FROM THE PHOSPHORYLATED PROTEIN IN PRESENCE OF METAL IONS E + PPSer( 14 C) E+

32p32p

^ ^

E - PPSer( 14 C) — E

_ 3 2

p

3 2

p

Mg+2^

+2

EP + PSer( 14 C)

• £

_ 32 p

+

32 p

Me +2

Substrates

Specific activity cpm

PPSer( 14 C)

4 000

-

PPSer( C)

4 000

Zn

32p32p 32p32p

3 125

-

3 095

3 125

Mg

1 500

14

When the

Protein cpm 3 840 -

14 C -labelled substrate was used, no label was found in the protein at

this step. In the case of pyrophosphate the addition of magnesium ions to the labelled protein decreases the amount of the label in it twofold. At this step of the reaction the phosphorylated enzyme is formed which is then hydrolyzed to yield f r e e enzyme and inorganic phosphate (step c). This reaction has been proved to be reversible and the most convenient one for preparation of phosphorylated enzyme. It has been proved that the interaction of the enzyme with inorganic phosphate results in phosphorylation of the enzyme active site. Thus, the enzyme-pyrophosphate interaction proceeds via formation of several covalent intermediates. The pyrophosphorylated enzyme is formed at the first step and phosphorylated one - at the next. It should be noted that formation of phosphorylated enzymes has been shown to occur in many cases. But much more surprizing is the fact that whole substrate molecule must bind to enzyme prior to its hydrolysis. Formation of a similar substrate enzyme compounds was also reported last year for nucleoside-triphosphate-adenosinemonophosphate transphosphorylase (8) and myosine (9).

9 The data obtained gave rise to the next problem - which amino acid is phosporylated in the enzyme? The effect of pH on the release of phosphoric acid from the phosphorylated protein was examined after 2 hour incubation at 37°C (Fig. 2). It is clear that the phosphorous bond stability varies with pH, the hydrolysis being most intensive in acidic medium. These data are not sufficient to rich the conclusion about the nature of the linkage between phosphate and protein. It is a matter of common knowledge that the stability of phosphate residue in proteins is determined by interactions with other functional groups of the protein. It is important that different methods of degradation of the phosphorylated protein yield various phosphorylated fragments (10,11). It must be borne in mind that phosphorylation of the following residues in proteins - serine and cysteine, basic and carboxylic groups may occur. In the case of inorganic pyrophosphatase there are much fewer possibilities, since serine and cysteine should be excluded. The conclusion is based on the experiments with diisopropylfluorophosphate (12). This well-known inhibitor of serine enzymes suppresses the activity of pyrophosphatase only when used at extremely high concentrations. But at such concentrations the activity of the enzyme also decreases in the presence of alcohols, acetone and ether. It should be noted that diisopropylfluorophosphate behaves as a competitive and reversible inhibitor. As to the participation of cysteine in the active centre of the molecule, we failed to confirm the evidence of the presence of the SH-group in the active centre (13). The activity of the enzyme remains constant in the presence of p-chloromercuribenzoate, 5, 5' -dithiobis (2-nitrobenzoic acid) and alkylating agents. Consequently, as we could expect either the amino or carboxyl group to be phosphorylated in pyrophosphatase we were first to try the phosphorylated protein for phosphohistidine and acylphosphate. The routine method separation of phosphohistidine from protein is alkaline hydrolysis. This procedure has been employed to prove the presence of phosphohistidine in a number of proteins. We hydrolyzed the phosphorylated pyrophosphatase with 3N sodium hydroxide for 4 hours and separated the mixture on a Dow ex column (Fig. 3). Phosphoric acid proved to be the only radioactive substance. These experiments have proved the absence of the phosphohistidine in phosphorylated enzyme. But alkaline treatment of phosphorylated pyrophosphatase was to be studied more closely. Phosphorylated enzyme was preincubated in subalkaline medium

10 (pH 10, 24 hours, 20°), than hydrolyzed with 3N sodium hydroxide. In this case hydrolyzate contained phosphohistidine (Fig. 4). Phosphohistidine can be also found after preincubation of phosphorylated protein with pronase (pH 7, 4 hours, 37°C) or IN sodium hydroxide at room temperature (12 hours). So it was shown that phosphohistidine could be isolated but it was a by-product and was formed as a result of the phosphoric acid residue migration to histidine. This migration takes place owing to the convertion of ammonium groups of protein into active nucleophilic agents in subalkaline medium. It should be noted that phosphohistidine is known to be a part of phosphorylated enzymes, but it seems in the light of our findings that at least some of the published data should be reviewed. Important results were got in experiments with hydroxylamine. As rule interaction of phosphorylated protein with hydroxylamine at pH 7 is used for revealing acylphosphate group. We have shown that phosphohistidine also reacts with hydroxylamine, the rate constant of phosphate release being 0,16 min~ M~ . So both acylphosphate and phosphohistidine residues in protein can react with hydroxylamine.

0 n~

In both reactions phosphoric acid is liberated but the behaviour of the enzyme is quite different in the two cases. Inhibition of the enzyme must be observed only after reaction of acylphosphate group. Really the activity of pyrophosphatase after 15 min incubation with pyrophosphate and 0.4M NHgOH at pH 7 decreased twofold. The fact can be explained by the existence of the acylphosphate bond in the phosphorylated protein. But as we had only indirect data about acylphosphate group in the protein it was necessary to find a chemical reaction resulting in a derivative of the carboxyl group which is stable under the conditions of protein peptide bonds hydrolysis. We turned to the well-known reaction of cyanide with carbonic acid chlorides yielding a ketonitril.

11 RC0C1 + CN"

RCOCN + CI"

If acylphosphate behaves like acidchloride, in the case of protein the product would be a protein ketonitril and after hydrolysis - ketoamino acid nitril and then ketoaminodicarbonic acid.

E-C—0—P4. Under these conditions 70% of the enzymatic activity were recovered. The sedimentation coefficient of the renatured product was determined to be S^q = 4.8, a value very near to that of 4.7 for the native enzyme.

23 Dilution experiments indicate that the renaturation is a fast process. Under optimal conditions more than 50% of the enzymatic activity are restored in less than one minute. Inorganic pyrophosphatase contains two SH -groups. They possess only a low reactivity against modifing reagents. The treatment with disulfides, i. e. DTNB or GSSG which must be employed in high concentrations, causes a decrease of the SH content of the enzyme due to the formation of mixed disulfides. The catalytic activity is only influenced to a small extent by this mdification. The sedimentation coefficient of the modified enzyme is lower than that of the native protein.

Further investigations are necessary to clarify this effect.

REFERENCES (1) EIFLER, R . , S. RAPOPORT, Third FEBS Meeting, Warsaw 1966, Abstract F168, p. 264 (2)

AVAEVA, S.M., E.M. BRAGA, A.M. EGOROV, Biofizika 13, (1968), 1126

(3)

SCHACHMAN, H. K., J . Gen. Physiol. 35, (1952), 451

(4)

MARTIN, R.G., B. N. AMES, J. Biol. Chem. 236, (1961), 1372

(5)

ZWAAN, J . , Analyt. Biochem. 21, (1967), 155

(6)

ULLMANN, A.,261 M. E. GOLDBERG, D. PERRIN, J . MONOD, Biochemistry 7, (1968),

(7)

TANFORD, C., K. KAWAHARA, S. LAPANJE, J . Amer. Chem. Soc. 89, (1967), 729 SHAPIRO, A. L . , E. VINUELA, J. V. MAIZEL, Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 28, (1967), 815

(8) (9)

EIFLER, R., unpublished results

24

i S 9 Protein concentration (mglml)

Fig. 1. Dependency of l / M ^ p of inorganic pyrophosphatase and bovine serum albumin on the protein concentration.

20w

Sedimentation coefficients Pyrophosphatase

of inorganic

¿P

P

Protein concentration

(mg/mt)

Fig. 2. Sedimentation velocity studies of inorganic pyrophosphatase in NaCl-Tris* HCl buffer pH 7. 2.

Fraction number

Fig. 3. Sedimentation studies in a 2 to 17 percent sucrose gradient at 40, 000 rev/min, 15 h, and 4°.

25

Density gradient Pyrophosphatase

5»"4

XT' Protein

centritugation

2-10" concentration

of

3-10 < rng /ml

inorganic

)

Fig. 4. Determination of molecular weight of inorganic pyrophosphatase by sucrose density gradient centrifugation at different protein concentrations.

2

s fYotein concentration

10 (mg/mt)

Fig. 5. l/Mgnp (1-V*9 ) values in 6. 0 M guanidine hydrochloride as a function of protein concentration.

Institut f ü r Physiologische und Biologische Chemie der Humboldt-Universität zu Berlin

P. HEITMANN,

Ch. M 6 L L E R K E , H . - J .

UHLIG

ON T H E S T A T E O F AROMATIC AMINO ACIDS O F INORGANIC PYROPHOSPHATASE FROM BAKER'S YEAST

For a detailed understanding of the mechanism of an enzymatic it i s important to know the spatial arrangement of the amino acids in the enzyme molecule. Great p r o g r e s s was made in this field by means of X - r a y crystallography. But other techniques a r e also useful to approach this problem. Among them the characterization of the state of the amino acids in the protein by spectroscopic methods and modification experiments plays an important p a r t . The present paper deals with the state of the tyrosyl and tryptophyl residues of inorganic pyrophosphatase (pyrophosphate phosphohydrolase, E. C. 3. 6.1.1) from b a k e r ' s yeast. Both the phenolic group a s well a s the indole residue a r e powerful chromophores. It i s possible to calculate the tyrosine and tryptophan content of a protein by comparison of its ultraviolet spectrum with those of corresponding low molecular weight model compounds. In order to ensure a great structural correspondence of the chromophores in the protein and in the model system Na-acetyl-L-tyrosine methylamide and Noe-acetyl-L-tryptophan methylamide were used for this purpose. In the range of 250-300 nm the absorption properties of both compounds w e r e found to be nearly identical with those d e s cribed in the literature for the corresponding ethyl e s t e r s or amides. In o r d e r to obtain p r e c i s e r e s u l t s it i s necessary to normalize the absorption of the protein chromophores. According to the procedure suggested by EDELHOCH (1) the spectroscopic measurements w e r e performed in 6 . 0 M guanidine hydrochloride. This powerful denaturant strongly reduces or eliminates the effects of specific interactions within the protein molecule on the spectroscopic p r o p e r t i e s of the chromophores. Using this method the total numbers of m o l e s tyrosine and tryptophan per mole inorganic pyrophosphatase w e r e determined to b e 24 and 14 on a molecular weight b a s i s of 70, 000. The tyrosine value a g r e e s well with that obtained by chromatographical analysis (2).

28 It is well known that the spectral properties of the tyrosyl and tryptophyl side chains are sensitive to changes of their environment. As a rule, a decrease of the polarity of the surrounding medium leads to a slight red shift of the absorption peaks and a small increase of their intensity. By means of the difference spectroscopic technique this effect can readily be used to study processes which are accompanied by an alteration of the environment of the chromophoric groups. Especially the solvent perturbation method developed by HERSKOVITS and LASKDWSKI (3,4) has been employed to examine the location of tyrosyl and tryptophyl residues in globular proteins. In this method mild non-aqueous additives, so-called perturbants, for instance polyhydroxy compounds are used to change the polarity of the solvent. In proteins only those chromophores which are accessible to the perturbant possess the ability to "recognize" the change of the solvent composition. Fig. 1 shows the solvent perturbation spectra of the model compounds here described. They have been recorded with a Cary 14 double-beam spectrophotometer. The observed perturbant effect was produced by 20% ethylene glycol. Fig. 2. indicates how a chromophoric group can be located in a macromolecule. The chromophores can be classified in four groups: fully exposed (I), partially exposed (II), buried (m), and those in crevices (IVa and IVb). The solvent perturbation spectrum of inorganic pyrophosphatase due to 20% ethylene glycol is presented in figure 3 (solid line). From a comparison of these data with those obtained with the model compounds it was calculated that 15-16 tyrosyl and 2. 3 tryptophyl residues are exposed to the solvent in this enzyme. One should point out that these values represent an average exposure. For instance, a value of 1 may mean that one residue is fully exposed or 2 residues are 50% exposed. The dashed line in Fig. 3 is a solvent perturbation spectrum of a mixture, which contains the model compounds in Tyr-Try ratio corresponding to the values calculated for pyrophosphatase. Fig. 4 demonstrates the effect of 8. 0 M urea on the solvent perturbation spectrum of inorganic pyrophosphatase. As expected the accessibility of the chromophoric groups to the solvent is found to be considerably enhanced by urea. 19-21 tyrosyl residues and 11-12 tryptophyl groups are exposed under these conditions. The conclusions about the location of the tyrosyl residues in inorganic pyrophosphatase drawn from the solvent perturbation experiments are confirmed by the results of a spectrophotometric titration of the enzyme. The titration curve presented in Fig. 5 shows that most of the tyrosyl residues exhibit a normal

29 titration behaviour with a pK& value of about 10. Approximately 16 groups a r e titrated at pH 11. The remaining residues (6-8) require a higher pH value to become ionized. At pH 13 about 21 tyrosyl residues exist in the ionized form. The data of the modification studies are in accordance with the results obtained from solvent perturbation and titration experiments. Tetranitromethane has been used frequently as a very powerful reagent for the nitration of phenolic groups in proteins (5, 6). Fig. 6 indicates that approximately 10 tyrosyl residues of inorganic pyrophosphatase a r e readily nitrated. Even when a very high excess of reagent is employed no more than 15 residues can be modified. This result corresponds to data obtained in modification studies with a 200-400 fold molar excess of N-acetylimidazole (7), in which about 13 tyrosyl residues could be acetylated. In the presence of 8. 0 M urea the number of tyrosyl residues nitrated by an excess of tetranitromethane amounts to 19. From this result and the corresponding data of the solvent perturbation experiments the conclusion can be drawn that the enzyme molecule ist not fully unfolded in 8. 0 M urea. An analogous behaviour is known for many other proteins. The effect of the nitration of the tyrosyl residues on the enzymatic activity is demonstrated in Fig. 7. A total loss of the enzymatic activity is observed even when only 2-3 tyrosyl residues a r e modified. Therefore it may be possible that tyrosyl groups a r e involved in the catalytic process.

Table NUMBER OF ACCESSIBLE TYROSYL AND TRYPTOPHYL RESIDUES IN INORGANIC PYROPHOSPHATASE

Solvent perturbation

Tyrosine (total number 24) 15-16 (19-21)

Tryptophan (total number 14) 2.3 (11-12)

Titration pH 11

16

pH 13

21

Reaction with TNM

15

Reaction with Ac-Im

13

(19)

The values in parantheses are determined in the presence of 8. 0 M urea.

30

Another explanation of this effect might be that these residues are necessary for maintaining the correct spatial structure of the active center. Further studies are necessary to decide between these two possibilities. The table summarize the data regarding the state of tyrosyl and tryptophyl residues in inorganic pyrophosphatase from baker' s yeast.

REFERENCES (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7)

EDELHOCH, H,, Biochemistry 6, (1967), 1948 EIFLER, R., R. GLAESMER, S. RAPOPORT, Acta Biol. Med. German. 17, (1966), 716 HERSKOVTTS, T. T., M. SORENSEN, Biochemistry 7, (1968), 2523 HERS KDVITS, T . T . , M. LASKDWSKI, J r . , J. Biol. Chem. 235, (1960), 56 RIORDAN, J. F . , M. SOKOLOWSKY, B. L. VALLEE, Biochemistry 6, (1967), 3609 BEAVEN, G.H., W.B. GRATZER, Biochim. Biophys. Acta 168, (1968), 456 RIORDAN, F . , W. E. C. WACKER, B. L. VALLEE, Biochemistry 4, (1965), J.1758

31

300 Ac

Fig. 1. Solvent perturbation experiments with Noc-acetyl-Ltyrosine methylamide (Tyr) and Na-acetyl-Ltryptophan methyl amide (Try) at pH 6.8. 270

280

290

Wave length (nm)

Fig. 3. Solvent perturbation experiments with inorganic pyrophosphatase and a synthetic mixture of model compounds at pH 6.8.

300

Wave length (nm)

Fig. 4. Influence of 8. 0 M urea on the solvent perturbation spectrum of inorganic pyrophosphatase at pH 6. 8.

Fig. 5. Titration curve of the tyrosyl residues of inorganic pyrophosphatase.

33

Fig. 6. Modification of the tyrosyl residues of inorganic pyrophosphatase with tetranitromethane (20 °C, pH 8, time 1 h).

Fig. 7. Dependence of the catalytic activity of inorganic pyrophosphatase on the number of nitrated tyrosyl residues.

Faculty of Biology and Soil Science, Moscow Lomonosov State University, Institute of Biochemistry and Physiology of Microorganisms, USSR Academy of Science

I.S. KULAEV PHOSPHOTRANSFERASE REACTIONS IN THE INORGANIC POLYPHOSPHATE METABOLISM

High polymeric polyphosphates have been found in living organisms as far back as at the close of the last century. The intensive study of their structure and metabolism has however been started only in the middle of this century. The most important results (1) have been obtained in the laboratories of J. P. EBEL, A. N. BELOZERSKY, K. LOHMANN, O. HOFFMANN-OSTENHOF and A. KORNBERG. Studies of J. P. EBEL (3) showed that the high polymeric polyphosphates isolated from the biological materials were the linear polymers, in which the residues of orthophosphates are bound between themselves by the energy-rich bonds as in the case of terminal residues of phosphates in ATP molecule. The high polymeric polyphosphate structures are shown in Fig. 1. The molecule of such polyphosphates can contain as much as 300-500 residues of the orthophosphate. These compounds are rather widely distributed among the living organisms, especially in microorganisms, where they can sometimes account for 10-20% of the dry weight of the cells. But in small quantities they were found in different tissues of both higher plants and animals. Besides information about polyphosphate structure, evidence for enzymes of polyphosphate metabolism was step by step, accumulated. The first isolated enzyme was ATP: polyphosphate phosphotransferase (4,5) which catalyzed transfer of energy-rich phosphate residue from ATP to polyphosphates and from polyphosphates to ADP with the formation of ATP according to reaction, presented in Fig. 2. The most purified form of the enzyme was isolated from E. coli by A. KQRNBERG. After the discovery of this enzyme high polymeric polyphosphates have become regarded (6) as some kind of "phosphagens" compounds similar to creatine-

36 phosphate and argininephosphate. From this point of view polyphosphates may be synthesized and utilized only through the ADP-ATP system. Since polyphosphates are accumulated in substantial quantities in microorganisms they were called microbial phosphagenes. Besides ATP:polyphosphatephosphotransferase another enzyme was isolated, in EBEL's laboratory i. e. polyphosphate: AMP phosphotransferase (7). The enzyme performed the transfer of phosphoryl residues from polyphosphate to AMP with the ADP formation or vice versa. The discovery of this enzyme seemed to have confirmed once again the thesis that the polyphosphate functions first of all were closely connected with the maintenance of the required level of intra-cellular ATP and ADP. That was one more reason to ascribe them the role of "microbial phosphagenes" (8). But shortly afterwards, the view-point on physiological role of polyphosphates was changed. This followed primarily as a result of M. SZYMONA's discovery (9). He found a new enzyme-polyphosphate: glucose-phosphotransferase which (Fig. 3) catalyzes the transfer reaction of phosphoryl group from polyphosphate to glucose followed by glucose-6-phosphate formation in Mycobacteria. The discovery of this enzyme proved on the one hand the possibility of polyphosphate utilisation without ATP-ADP system participation and on the other that in some cases polyphosphates could play the role of ATP itself. Indeed, the reaction, reported by Dr. SZYMONA, was analogous to the wellknown hexokinase reaction, in which glucose phosphorylation proceeds at the expense of ATP. It is interesting to note that it has been shown in that same laboratory recently, that there is a number of adaptive enzymes, which carry out reactions of transfer of phosphate group from polyphosphates also by passing adenylic system not to glucose but to other monosaccharides and their derivatives (10, 11). Besides M. A. BOBYK, O. SZYMONA and I have recently discovered another enzyme (12, 13) which catalyzed the reaction of polyphosphate synthesis in Neurospora crassa (Fig. 4). This reaction proceeds at the expense of energy-rich phosphate 1,3 - diphosphoglyceric acid. The new enzyme - 1,3-diphosphoglycerate: polyphosphatephosphotransferase, carried out the reaction analogous to the well known reaction of ATP formation in the process of glycolytic phosphorylation. Thus, in the case of the reaction, discovered by us, high polymeric, polyphosphates seems to play the role usually characteristic of ATP-ADP system. These

37 data present a great interest in the light of the assumption, put forward by A. N. BELOZERSKY in 1957 concerning the evolution of the phosphorous metabolism (14). In his report made at the I. International Symposium on the problems of origin of life A. N. BELOZERSKY assumed that high polymeric polyphosphates in protobionts could carry out the functions which in contemporary organisms were mainly performed by ATP. To test this assumption we investigated the distribution of enzymes carrying out the reactions utilizing the polyphosphates and ATP for phosphorylation of the same substrate in different microorganisms which are at different stages of the evolutionary scale. For this purpose the study of distribution of two enzymes - polyphosphate: glucosephosphotransferase and ATP: glucosephosphotransferase (hexokinase) has been widely carried out in different microorganisms (15-17). Many species of different classes of microorganisms - bacteria, actinomycetes, fungi, green and blue-green algae, have been studied. It was found that hexokinase is present in all the microorganisms studied (Fig. 5), polyphosphate: glucose-phosphotransferase is found only in the organisms, which belong to the class of actinomycetes according to the classification scheme of N. A. KRASILNIKOV (18) and which are included in this class by the common origin according to KLUYVER and van NIEL (19). Fig. 5 shows that not all the species studied have polyphosphate; glucosephosphotransferase even among the microorganisms which are usually included in the class of actinomycetes by N. A. KRASILNIKOV (18). It is interesting to point out that almost all the species which do not posses this enzymatic activity are classified as actinomycetes only formally and by far not by all taxonomists. When the specific activities of the two enzymes of the organisms which have both the enzymes were compared a very interesting fact was established. Table 1 shows that the ration between the specific activities of these enzymes changes from one species to another. The specific activity of polyphosphate: glucose-phosphotransferase is considerably higher than that of hexokinase only in the organisms which according to KLUYVER and van NIEL are the most ancient from the phylogenetic point of view in this group. The hexokinase activity is considerably higher in the species which are phylogenetically younger.

38

Table 1 RATIO OF POLYPHOSPHATE GLUCOKINASE AND ATP-GLUCOKENASE SPECIFIC ACTIVITIES IN VARIOUS MICROORGANISMS (MM P/hour per mg of protein) poly-P-glucokinase

ATP-glucokinase

poly-P-glucokinase ATP-glucokinase

Micrococcus lisodeikticus

2

0.4

5

Sarcina lutea

2

0. 5

4

Pr opionbact er ium shermanii

6

0.6

10

5.2

0.6

9

M. scotochromogenus

14.2

7.1

2

M. phlei

10.1

7.8

M. smegmatis

16 10.6

14 9.3

1.3 1.2

Corynebacterium xerosis Nocardia turbatus

7.5

3.7

1.1 2

3

0. 9

3.3

N. gardneri

4

3.4

1.2 0.8

Mycobacterium tuberculosis

M. friburgensis

N. bra siliensis N. madureae N. minima N. asteroides

6.6 1.3 9.5

5 9 10.3 4.7

11.6

1.1 0.4

3.6

7.6

0.5

7.3

7

Actinomyces olivaceus A. globisporus A. fradiae

4.8 1.8

16

0. 6 0.1

A. aureofaciens

2. 3

15.1

0.1

Some conclusions can be drawn from these data. First, the presence of some constitutive enzymes, the enzymes of polyphosphate metabolism in particular can be considered a s an additional taxonomic feature helping to obtain more specific information about the evolutionary system of microorganisms. Second,

39 if it is true, then the results obtained clearly show that in certain reactions polyphosphates can almost completely replace ATP in the more ancient evolutionary forms, pertaining to the class of actinomycetes. One may suppose that at the very beginning of the origin of life on Earth polyphosphates could really perform functions which further were completely transferred to ATP. It is of great importance that the activity of the enzymatic system which catalyzes the synthesis of polyphosphates at the expense of glycolytic phosphorylation without the participation of ATP is the highest in the phylogenetically ancient microorganisms (20). Thus, on the basis of all the facts mentioned above one can suppose that high-polymeric polyphosphates could have really been the evolutionary precursors of ATP. We are inclined to believe that in protobionts they could be the main compounds (if not the only ones), coupling exergonic and endergonic reactions (see the reactions in Fig. 6). High polymeric polyphosphates could be synthesized at the expense of 1, 3-diphosphoglycericacid formed at the glycolytic splitting of glucose, and on the other hand, they could be used for its primary phosphorylation (21, 22). Returning again to the enzymes of polyphosphate metabolism we can say that besides the above mentioned enzymes having strongly pronounced phosphotransferase activity in some microorganisms other very interesting enzymes were found, whose action mechanism and role in polyphosphate metabolism are not sufficiently clear. First of all these are different polyphosphatases. All the polyphosphatases known can be divided into two groups. The polyphosphatases of the first group split highpolymeric polyphosphates to lower molecular fragments. These are the so called polyphosphate-polyphosphohydrolases. They catalyze the reaction, presented in Fig. 7. The polyphosphatases of the other group carry out the cleavage of orthophosphate molecules one by one at the end of the chain of a polyphosphate. These enzymes may be called polyphosphate-phosphohydrolases. They are resumed to catalyze the reaction, shown in Fig. 8. The data accumulated on high molecular polyphosphates permit to assume that physiological role of these two groups of polyphosphatases is basically different. First of all I should like to dwell upon the first group of the above enzymes, namely, polyphosphate-polyphosphohydrolases. It is long known that polyphosphates presented in the cells of microorganisms have different chain lengths. It was found that in microorganisms the higher polymeric fractions of polyphosphates play a role which essentially differs from that of the lower polymeric ones.

40 Our work performed in the laboratory of A. N. BELOZERSKY (23) and also the work of P. LANGEN in laboratory of K. LOMANN (24) showed that lower molecular polyphosphates are mainly formed from the higher polymeric ones by means of gradual degradation. Further in our laboratory I. A. KRASHENNIKOV and T. P. AFANASYEVA working on the cells pf Neurospora crassa and Endomyces magnusii established (25, 26) that high polymeric polyphosphates were localized on the outside of the cells, near the external cytoplasmic membrane and lower polymeric polyphosphates - within the cells, in the nuclei and granules of volutine, in particular. One may suppose that the highest polymeric polyphosphates play some very important role in the functioning of the cytoplasmatic membrane, in the transport of ions and substances through it in particular. The lower polymeric, polyphosphates, which are localized in the volutine granules, may be considered to be a reserve of macroergic phosphate. Thus, polyphosphatases, depolymerizing high polymeric polyphosphates to lower polymeric fragments, perform apparently a very important function in the cells, namely intracellular translocation of polyphosphates from the outside of the cells inside. In our laboratory M. S. KRITZKY, E. K. CHERNYSHOVA and G. I. KONOSHENKD have studied polyphosphatases, depolymerizing high polymeric polyphosphates in Neurospora crassa. Two very interesting facts have been established: first, these enzymes split the polyphosphate molecule in the middle of the chain, and second, these enzymes were localized in the cell just with the highest polymeric polyphosphates, i. e. outside of the cell, between the cell wall and cytoplasmic membrane. These results are in good agreement with the fact that polyphosphate polyphosphohydrolases take part first of all in the transfer of polyphosphates through cell membrane with simultaneous splitting of their molecules. One may assume that the very long chains of polyphosphates can not penetrate into the cell and a partial fragmentation of them is necessary. From the point of view of Dr. Kritzky it is very likely that the energy of phosphoanhydride bond, released in the course of the polyphosphate splitting, can be used for the translocation of the obtained fragments through the cell membrane. The other group of polyphosphatases, i. e. polyphosphate-phosphohydrolases, gradually chipping off one molecule of orthophosphate at a time from high polimeric polyphosphates at the end of the chain, play quite a different role in metabolic processes. Together with G. I. KONOSHENKD we studied Neurospora crassa

41

and found that these enzymes a s well as depolymerases had been localized mainly or exclusively outside the cell near the external cytoplasmic membrane (27) together with the more physiologically active high polymeric polyphosphates. It seems very likely that polyphosphate phosphohydrolases function in vivo first of all as phosphotransferases releasing at the gradual splitting polyphosphate to orthophosphate the energy for nutrient and ion transport through the cell membrane. It seems very likely that the action of the enzymes of this kind may be analogous to this of pyrophosphatase and ATPase. As for pyrophosphatase M. R. STETTEN (28) a s well a s R. C. NORDLE and W. J. ARION (29) established that it can not only hydrolize pyrophosphate but also at certain conditions transfers one of the chipped phosphates to one or the other substrate. On the other hand H. BALTSCHEFFSKY and M. BALTSCHEFFSKY (30) showed that this enzyme could take part in reverse electron transport along the respiratory chain and also in transport of ions through membrane. As to ATPase it is well known that ATPase takes part in transport of ions and substances through different cell membranes. Not very long ago van STEVENINCK et al. (31, 32) have experimentally established the participation of polyphosphates in sugar transport through cytoplasmic membrane of yeasts. At the same time they found that polyphosphates took part in phosphorylation of phosphatidylglycerate to phosphatidylglycerophosphate in membrane, the latter being probably the donor of phosphate for the formation of an active complex of the carrier and the transported sugar. The reaction postulated by van STEVENINCK et al. can be seen in Fig. 9. From our point of view it seems very likely that polyphosphate phosphohydrolases take part in such phosphotransferase reactions connected with the transport of substances through the external cytoplasmic membrane. It is very interesting to note that another specific enzyme of the same kind has been found in a number of microorganisms: tripolyphosphate-phosphohydrolase (or tripolyphosphatase) (33-35) which hydrolizes tripolyphosphate to orthophosphate and pyrophosphate according to the scheme, presented in Fig. 10. According to our results this enzyme, obtained from Neurospora crasse, is mainly localized in mitochondria (27). It is necessary to underline that all the enzymes of high molecule polyphosphate metabolism (as well a s polyphosphates themselves) a r e completely absent in these organelles. At the present time the role of this enzyme in mitochondria is quite obscure but it is very likely that

42 this enzyme is similar to a pyrophosphatase taking part in the reverse transport of electrons along the respiratory chain as well a s in ion transport through the mitochondrial membrane. However this supposition requires further investigations. One of the works of our laboratory, made jointly with E. I. VOROBYOVA, deals with the detection of the potential ability of different enzymes, participating in polyphosphate metabolism, to biosynthesis and utilization of these phosphorus compounds. This work was performed on one organism - Propionibacterium shermanii. Moreover, it was shown that the accumulation of polyphosphates at different culture growth stages is in good agreement with the potential possibilities of the action of ATP: polyphosphatephosphotransferase, 1. 3-diphosphoglycerate; polyphosphatephosphotransferases and polyphosphate - phosphohydrolases. The increase of the two former enzymes activities coincided with the polyphosphate accumulation rate observed at the early stage of P. shermanii development. The polyphosphate-phosphohydrolase activity, arising at the stationary phase of growth correlated very well to the termination of polyphosphate accumulation in cells observed at this stage of growth. Thus, it is the activity of these enzymes only that explains the character of the polyphosphate accumulation curve in the studied organisms. In addition, the very active polyphosphate: glucosephosphotransferase, taking part in phosphorylation of glucose to glucose-6-phosphate, has been revealed in the same cells. Its activity was found to be two orders higher than the activities of the enzymes mentioned above and it failed to agree with the accumulation curve of high polymeric polyphosphates in cells of P. shermanii. It is very difficult to explain the results obtained for the present. It may be connected either with the latent condition of polyphosphate: glucosephosphotransferase in cells or with our poor knowledge of the main enzymatic mechanism of polyphosphates biosynthesis which could supply this enzyme with the substrate required. The second suggestion seems to be more likely. If it is true, then there must exist in P. shermanii a s well a s in some other organisms, some yet unknown pathways of polyphosphate biosynthesis, working about a hundred times more actively than that of pathways known at present. It seems very probable and tempting that this pathways may turn out to be biosynthesis of high polymeric polyphosphates at the expense of pyrophosphate according to the reaction presented in Fig. 11.

43 Availability of the close correlative relationship between accumulation of certain fractions of polyphosphates, RNA and polysaccharides in fungi cells (36-38) gives us indirect evidence for the existence of this kind of reaction. This hypothetic assumption concerning the possibility of biosynthesis of high polymeric polyphosphates at the expense of nucleic acids and polysaccharides at the expense of pyrophosphate released during the biosynthesis reactions is the only one which can explain the possibility of such correlation. Usually it is considered that pyrophosphates formed in different biosynthesis reactions is split by pyrophosphatase to orthophosphate (39, 40). It seems to us that in some cases there may take place not the hydrolysis of pyrophosphate but the transfer of one of the phosphates from pyrophosphate to polyphosphate with the lengthening of its molecule and reservation of energy of pyrophosphate linkage. Such a way of pyrophosphate removal from the reaction seems to be far more advantageous from the point of view of cell economy. At present we are working on the proof to this possibility and this idea seems rather realistic. In conclusion I would like to remind you that at present there is a certain progress in studying phosphotransferases and other enzymes participating in polyphosphate metabolism. However one can hope that the next few years will bring us many new facts which will help us to understand clearly the physiological role of high polymeric polyphosphates and the participation of various phosphotransferases in polyphosphate metabolism.

REFERENCES (1)

KULAEV, I . S . , A. W. BELOZERSKY, Izv. Akad. NaukUSSRSer. biol. 3, (1962), 354and 4, (1962), 502

(2)

HAROLD, F . M . , Bacteriol. reviews 30, (1966), 772

(3)

EBEL, J . P . , Bull Soc. Chem. Biol. 34, (1952), 330

(4)

HOFFMANN-OSTENHOF, O., J . KENDY, K. KEEK, O. GABRIEL, K. SCHONFELLINGER, Biochim. Biophys. Acta 14, (1954), 285

(5)

KDRNBERG, A., S. KDRNBERG, E. SIMMS, Biochim.Biophys.Acta, 20, (1956), 215

(6)

HOFFMANN-OSTENHOF, O., Colloq. Intern. Centre, Natl. Rech. Sci. (Paris) 106, (1962), 640

(7)

DIRHEIMER, G., J . P. EBEL, Compt. Rend. Soc. Biol. 260, (1965), 3787

(8)

LANGEN, P., Biol. Rundsch. 2, (1965), 145

SZYMONA, M . , M. OSTROWSLI, Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 85, (1964), 283 SZYMONA, O . , T. SZUMILO, Acta Biochim. Polon. 17, (1966), 129 SZYMONA, O . , H. KOWALSKA, M. SZYMONA, Annales Universitatis M. Curie-Sklodowska (Lublin) 24, (1969), 1 KULAEV, I . S . , O. SZYMONA, M. A. BOBYK, Biochimia, 33, (1968), 419 KULAEV, I . S . , M. A. BOBYK, Biochimia 36, (1971), 426 BELOZERSKY, A. N., In book "Origin of Life on the Earth", "Nauka", Moscow 1959, p. 370 SZYMONA, O . , S.O. URYSON, I.S. KULAEV, Biochimia, 32, (1967), 495 URYSON, S . O . , I.S. KULAEV, Dokl Akad. Nauk, 183, (1968), 957 URYSON, S . O . , I.S. KULAEV, Biochimia 35, (1970), 601 KRASILNIKOV, N. A . , "Mannual of Bacteria a Actinomycetes", "Nauka", 1942 KLUYVER, A . J . , C.B. van NIEL, Zentr. Bacteriol. Abt., 94, (1936), 369 KULAEV, I . S . , M. A. BOBYK, N.N. NIKOLAEV, N. A. SERGEEV, S.O. URYSON, Biochimia 36, (1971), 5 KULAEV, I. S . , In book "Abiogenesis and Initial Stages of the Evolution of Life" "Nauka", 1968 KULAEV, I . S . , In book "Molecular Evolution" vol. 1, "Chemical Evolution and Origin of Life". Amsterdam 1971 KULAEV, I . S . , A.N. BELOZERSKY, Biochimia 22, (1957), 587 LOHMANN, K., P. LANGEN, Biochem. Z . , 328, (1956), 1 KULAEV, I.S. T. P. AFANASIEVA, I. A. KRASHENINNIKOV, S. E. MANSUROVA, Proc. of 2nd Intern. Symp. on Yeast protoplasts, Brno, 1970 KULAEV, I. S . , T. P. AFANASIEVA, Autonie vanLeeuwenhock, Suppl. Yeast Symposium, 35, (1969), 13 KULAEV, I. S . , G. I. KONOSHENKO, A. M. UMNOV, Biochimia, 36, (1971), 6 STETTEN, M . R . , J . B i o l . Chem. 239, (1964), 3576 NORDLE, R. C . , W . J . ARION, J . B i o l . Chem. 239, (1964), 1680 BALTSCHEFFSKY, H . , M. BALTSCHEFFSKY, L. V. von STEDINGK " P r o g r e s s in Photosynthesis Research", 3, (1969), 1313 STEVENINCK, J. van, H. L. BOOIJ, J . Gen. Physiol. 48, (1964) DEIERKAUF, F. A . , H. L. BOOJ, Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 150, (1968), 214 HAROLD, F . M . R. L. HAROLD, J . B a c t . 89, (1965), 1862 FELTER, S . , G. DIRHEIMER, J . P. EBEL, Bull.Soc., Chim. Biol. 52, (1970), 437 KULAEV, I . S . , G.I. KONOSHENKO, Biochimia 36, (1971), 4 KRITSKY, M . S . , T.A. BELOZERSKAJA, I.S. KULAEV, Dokl. Akad., Nauk, USSR, 180, (1968), 746

45 (37)

KRITSKY, M . S . , E . K . CHERNYSHOVA, I.S. KULAEV, Dokl.Akad. Nauk, USSR, 192, (1969), 1166

(38)

KULAEV, I. S., V. H. VAGABOV, A . B . ZYOMENKO, Biochimia in p r e s s (1972)

(39)

HOFFMANN-OSTENHOF, O . , L. SLECHTA, 1958 Proc. Intern. Symp. Enzym. Chem., Tokyo, Kyoto, 2, (1957), 180

(40)

KORNBERG, A . , In book "Horisons in Biochemistry, Ed. M. KASHA and B. PULLMAN, Acad. P r e s s , N. Y. a London 1962

46

f I -O-P-O-P-O-P-O 0

0

0

(n+2)~ P—0— 0

(M^+HJn

Fig. 1. Inorganic polyphosphate

ATP + (poly-P) —— ADP+(poly-P) n+ i Fig. 2. The scheme of ATP: polyphosphate phosphotransferase reaction.

CH20H

CH 2 O-( |+(po/y-P)nH

hexokinase D-glucose

D-glucose-6-®

Fig. 3. The scheme of polyphosphate hexokinase reaction.

C00~®

(jOOH

CHOH +(poly-P)n—CHOH CH2O-

0

85

.

390 10

-2

200

_

_

M

The effect of substrate concentration: It can be seen in Fig. 3, that the excess of substrate inhibits the rate of polyphosphate depolymerization by a non-dialyzed enzyme preparation. The inhibition may be most likely explained by the presence in the cell free extract of metal cations, activating the reaction. The increase of substrate concentration, probably, leads to the formation of metal-polyphosphate complexes which is resulted in disappearance of free metal ions from the reaction and the decrease of reaction rate. After dialysis of the enzyme preparation, no inhibition of the reaction rate by the substrate is observed. It can be seen, however, that the dependence of reaction velocity from the Michaellis-Menten hyperbola. This deviation is especially obvious when plotting the same data on a double reciprocal plot. Here, instead of a straight line characteristic for classical Michaellis-Menten kinetics, we find the curve concave upward. The curves of such a shape are observed when two or more active sites with positive cooperativity between them participate in the process (LEVITZKI, KOSHLAND, 1969).

52

The effect of orthophosphate on the reaction rate: Since orthophosphate concentrations both inside and outside the cell, are the key factors in the regulation of the activity of enzymes participating in phosphorous metabolism, we have studied the effect of orthophosphate on polyphosphate depoly-3 merase activity. At the concentration of substrate ( P o l y P - g ^ 8 x 1 0 M the permanent diminishment of the activity as a function of increased orthophosphate 2 concentration is observed, and at 5 x 10 M orthophosphate completely inhibits the hydrolysis. However, further investigation has revealed the influence of orthophosphate on the depolymerase activity is more complex, than mere inhibition. When studying -3 the effect of orthophosphate (1, 3 x 10 M), under various concentrations of substrate, we have found, that inhibitory effect is manifested only with sufficiently -2 high substrate concentration, not less than 0, 85 • 10

M. Under the smaller

concentration of polyphosphate in the incubation mixture, orthophosphate enhances the rate of polyphosphate depolymerization (Fig. 4). Such double effect of orthophosphate may point to its participation in regulation of polyphosphate depolymerase activity, probably, as an effector of allosteric type. However, the complicated character of this process makes rather difficult the interpretation of its physiological significance in the regulation of polyphosphate metabolism. Polyphosphate depolymerase activities in the course of mycelium growth: The data mentioned above, has given no answer, whether various polyphosphate depolymerases exist, specifically adapted f i r the substrates with various n, or degradation of polyphosphate fractions with various n is carried out by the same enzyme molecules. Some light onto this problem could be thrown from the comparison of the changes of activities splitting polyphosphates with different n during the growth cycle (Fig. 5). The activity, depolymerizing polyphosphate with initial n 290, gradually increases from the moment of condia germination, reaches a maximal value to the end of exponential growth, and falls down after that. But in the experiments with polyphosphate n 180 taken as a substrate, in addition to the peak at the end of exponential phase, observed with the substrate n 290, the other one at the beginning of the exponential phase was revealed. Such different kind of behaviour of the activities, splitting polyphosphate preparations with n 290 and 180, may evidence for a possible existence of polyphosphate depolymerase hydrolyzinginaspecific manner the certain polyphosphate fractions.

53

Intracellular localization of polyphosphate depolymerase activity: The study of intracellular localization of polyphosphate depolymerase activity carried out in collaboration with G. Konoshenko, has revealed virtually all activity (either splitting polyphosphate with nQ290, or nQ 180) to be located in a periplasmic space, i. e. between cell wall and outer membrane. The removal of a cell wall by digestion with an enzyme complex of digestive sap of Helix pomatia leads to almost complete loss of activity (Table 2). No activity has been found in mitochondria and in hyaloplasm. On the same time, a minute activity could be observed in other components of the cell, in nuclei and microsomes. It is, however, so small, that entirely might be a result of contamination of these fractions with fragments of the outer cell membrane.

Table 2 INTRACELLULAR LOCALIZATION OF POLYPHOSPHATE DEPOLYMERASE ACTIVITY (mU/mgof protein) Substrate

Whole cells

Protoplasts

Nuclei

Mitochondria

Microsomes

Hyaloplasma

PolyP- 2 9 Q

7.8

PolyP- 1 f l n

9.4

0.6

0. 15

0.0

2.2

0.0

1.3

0.20

0.0

-

0.0

It should be mentioned here, that polyphosphate depolymerases splitting polyphosphates with n 290 and n 180, i. e. with a polymerization degrees close to that of the most high molecular polyphosphate fractions of N. crassa (CHERHYSHOVA, KRITSKY, KULAEV, 1971), have been found in the vicinity of their substrates, high molecular polyphosphate fractions which a r e also localized in a periplasmic space (KRASHENINNIKOV et a l . , 1971). By present views, polyphosphates a r e synthesized in the cell de novo, as the most high molecular fraction and then splitted by depolymerases to form various fractions with smaller n values (KULAEV, BELOZERSKY, 1962). If so, it would be reasonable to suggest, that polyphosphate depolymerases present in periplasmic region, participate in the involvment of the polyphosphates, formed out of cell membrane, into the intracellular metabolism. We can believe now, that these enzymes a r e related with the transfer of newly synthesized polyphosphate molecules through

54 the cell membrane into the protoplasm. In this case the energy produced by enzymatic splitting of P-O-P linkage might be utilized in the transfer of the polyphosphate molecules through the cell membrane into the inner zone of the cell.

REFERENCES CHERNYSHOVA, E. K., M.S. KRITSKY, I.S. KULAEV, Biokhimia, 36, (1971), 138 (in Russian) INGELMAN, B . , H. MALMGREN, Acta Chem. Scand., 3, (1949), 157 KRASHENENNIKOV, I. A., G.I. KONOSHENKO, S. E. MANSUROVA, A.M. UMNOV, I.S. KULAEV, This volume, 10, (1971) KONONSHENKO, G. I., This volume, communication, 9, (1971) KRISHNAN, P . S . , Arch. Biochem. Biophys., 37, (1952), 224 KULAEV, I. S., A. N. BELOZERSKY, Izvestia Akademii Nauk SSSR (Seria biologicheskaja), 4, (1962), 402 (in Russian) NISHI, A . , J. Biochem., (Japan), 48, (1960), 758

55

t ^ -

I

Suùsfrâ/p: Poly Ph 290,0,85- W' ZM

•ei S Fig. 1. The effect of enzyme concentration on the reaction rate.

-g c

protein of enzyme preparation, fig -

Substrate: Poty Pn0 290, 0.85 10~ 2M

Substrate: Poty Pn0 180, 0.85- 10~ 2M

Fig. 2. The effect of pH on polyphosphate depolymerase activity.

Substrate: Poty Pfi0 290

4

9

p.--?""^ I

To

1

7 7 1 2

pH

Substrate: Poty Ph 290

7/VA

Fig. 3. The effect of substrate concentration on the reaction rate. 5ÛJ Substrate concentration (acid labile 2 phosphate),M- W~ ~

-

56 Substrate: Poly Pn 290

without ortho P^

1.3-W' 2MorthoP

ith

0

Fig. 4. The effect of orthophosphate upon the rate of polyphosphate depolymerase activity under different substrate concentrations.

_L

_L

7 2 3 Substrate concentration (acid labile , phosphate), M-1CT 2-

j

&0

growth curn

"if n0 180,

/ /

0

K

0.85*r u

\

/

/

« / 7

x

/ v / _L

M

2

_L

/

A \ \ x

v

I J 20% vI

n„ 290.0SS- Iff* W *

_L

3 6 W 16 20 age of mycelium of H.crass 28610 as, hours 1

0

§*

Fig. 5. The changes of polyphosphate depolymerase activities splitting polyphosphates with fio290 and 180 in the course of mycelium growth.

Bach Institute of Biochemistry of the USSR Academy of Sciences, Moscow, and Lomonosov State University, Moscow

TATIANA P. AFANASIEVA, V. V. ROTSCHANETZ SOME PROPERTIES OF POLYPHOSPHATASE FROM Endomyces magnusii

The present communication is concerned, in part, with the study of inorganic polyphosphate metabolism. It was headed by I. S. KULAEV who summarized its results and reported them to this Symposium. In studying the polyphosphates from Neurospora crassa and Endomyces magnusii it has been found that any destruction of their cell structure results in fast hydrolytic splitting of the high polymer polyphosphates on the outer cytoplasmic membrane to form orthophosphate. This process is likely to proceed under the action of the polyphosphatases which are also bound with the outer cell membrane, and are in the close vicinity of their substrates (KULAEV et a l . , 1970a). The polyphosphatases which hydrolyze high molecular polyphosphates to form orthophosphate were found in some microorganisms by a number of workers (MUHAMMED et a l . , 1959; HAROLD, HAROLD, 1965; FELTER et a l . , 1970). But the data available show that the properties of polyphosphatases from different biological sources such a s optimal pH or the nature of activators and inhibitors for the polyphosphatase reaction, vary considerably. The object of this work was to study the properties of the polyphosphate phosphohydrola.se from E. magnusii. Previously we have investigated the conditions for accumulation and specific intracellular localization of various polyphosphate fraction (KULAEV et a l . , 1967; AFANASIEVA et a l . , 1968; KULAEV et a l . , 1970b). The yeast cells used in the experiment were harvested at the end of the logarithmic phase. The cells were crushed in a French-press. The crushed material was suspended in 0. 05 M tris+maleate buffer pH 7.1 and then centrifuged at 20. OOOg and 0° for 30 min. The supernatant was dialyzed against buffer to remove salts and low molecular organic compounds. The resulting preparation could be stored for a long time at -15° without any appreciable loss of activity. The enzyme is rendered completely inactive by heating for 20 min. at 45°.

58

The enzyme may be partly purified by precipitation with ammonium sulphate. The specific activity of the fraction appearing between 60 and 80 % saturation with ammonium sulphate was more than twice as high as the initial one. A synthetic linear polyphosphate with a chain length of n=290 was used as a substrate for the enzyme reaction. The activity of the polyphosphatase was estimated from the increase of orthophosphate in the reaction mixture. The temperature of incubation mixture was 37°. The linear dependence of the reaction rate on time was recorded during the first 10 minutes. The effect of pH on the enzyme activity was studied in 0.1 M tris+maleate buffer at pH 5. 5 - 8. 5 (Fig. 1). The pH optimum was found to be about 7.1. A high ion strength of the incubation mixture containing KC1 (or NaCl) considerably hinders the polyphosphatase reaction. The salt concentration of 0.4 M almost completely inhibited the reaction (Fig. 2). Next, the effect of divalent metal ions on the polyphosphatase activity was studied. With such cations added to the preparation after its dialysis, the enzyme activity becomes 10 - 20 times as high. Fig. 3 shows the effect of various metal ion concentrations on the polyphosphatase activity. Mn + + at a final concentration of 2 x 10~ 3 M is the best activating agent. The activity of C o + + is almost as high as that of Mn + + . The effect of Mg + + is practically the same as that of Z n + + and is about 60 % of that of Mn + + . Ni** promotes the reaction but only slightly. The effect of the above cations decreases with increase of their concentration _o o ++ from 3 x 1 0 ° to 10 M. Fe is an activator of polyphosphatase when its -3 -2 3+ concentration is 10 M and is an inhibitor at 10 M. Fe does not show any activating properties. The optimal concentration ratio of the activating ion and substrate phosphate is equal to unity. EDTA completely removes the effect of cations. The composition of the incubation medium optimal for the determination of the -2 -3 polyphosphatase activity is: 2 x 10 M tris+maleate buffer pH 7.1; 2 x 10 M -3 MnCl„; 2 x 10 M (P) polyphosphate, n=290. The K value for the polyphosphatase a

111

from E.magnusii as determined according to LINEWEAVER and BURK (1934) A

is 3 x 10

M of phosphate in its polymer form with n=290 (Fig. 4).

Since inorganic polyphosphates are polyanions the cations of the surrounding medium should be responsible for the behaviour of the molecules of these compounds. The effect of some metal ions on the polyphosphatase reaction which has been found may be due to cation binding to a substrate moleculs. It results in specific changes of polyphosphate conformation and affects the following formation

59 of the enzyme-substrate complex and subsequent hydrolysis. The activating effect of the cations under study allows the following sequence: » » + + - — /-I ++ »» ++ Mn Co =» Mg

=

7 ++ ^ VT-++ Zn > TFe Ni



It should be pointed out that if another activating cation is added to the incubation mixture containing Mn + + the effect of the latter either increases or these cations are incompatible. Fig. 5 shows how simultaneous action of a number of cations of various concentration affects the polyphosphatase reaction rate. It has been found that C o + + increases the Mn + + effect, Mg + + does not almost affect the reaction, Ni + + and Zn + + decrease the Mn + + effect. F e + + stops the reaction completely. Cu + + , Ca + + , Hg + + , A l 3 + , Ag + (Fig. 6) and also Cd + + and UC>2++ show inhibition effect independent of the presence of Mn + + . According to WILLIAMS (1959) the cations which form less stable complexes with some compounds and inhibit their non-enzymatic hydrolysis activate the enzymatic decomposition of these compounds and vice verse. According to van STEVENINCK (1966) Mg + + , Zn + + , Co + + , and Ni + + inhibit the nonenzymatic hydrolysis of polyphosphates. At the same time we have shown that it is these cations which have an activating effect on the polyphosphatase reaction. Whereas uranylwhich superimposes on the H + -catalyzed hydrolysis of polyphosphate hinders enzymatic decomposition of these compounds. Thus, our findings are in accord with the Williams rule and enable definition of the polyphosphatase from E. magnusii as an enzyme which shows its activity only in the presence of Mn + + , Co + + , Mg + + or Zn + + . The metal ions seem to play an important role both in specific binding of the substrate and its combining with an enzyme molecule. This is evidenced by the fact that the preparation loses its activity after dialysis or in the presence of EDTA. It is also supported by the interchangeability of the ions and non-stechiometric ratio metal/protein. However, one should not rule out the possibility of metal presence in the active centre of the polyphosphatase as well. The inhibition effect of p - C l - Hg-benzoate on polyphosphatase and protecting properties of cystein during storage of the enzyme preparation and its incubation with a substrate provide evidence for a significant effect of sulphhydryl groups of protein on the polyphosphatase activity. This is also supported by the inhibiting effect of Ag + , Hg + + and Cd + + . Among the inhibitors of the polyphosphatase reaction are NaF and KCN, their inhibition effect being 35 % and 30 %, respectively.

60 Nucleoside-phosphates, ATP and UTP, also decrease the reaction rate. But this mechanism is still to be clarified. Table 1 shows the influence of the enzyme pre-incubation for 10 min. with various detergents on the polyphosphatase activity of dialysed preparation.

Table 1 Detergent

Concentration %

Inhibition %

Na-Dodecyl sulfate

0.05

100

Tween-80

0.10

100

Triton X-100

0.50

80

Deoxycholate

0.50

30

SDS shows the greatest inhibition effect. In 10 min. it completely supressed the polyphosphatase reaction. Tween-80 is also a strong inhibitor. Triton X-100 and deoxycholate, in particular, a r e less effective. The data obtained suggest that polyphosphatase is involved into the composition of lipoprotein systems of cell membranes and certain native conformation of these complexes is responsible for its activity. This is also evidenced by the localization of the enzyme on the outer cytoplasmic membrane.

REFERENCES AFANASIEVA, T. P . , I. S. KULAEV, S. E. MANSUROVA, V. Ju. POLJAKOV, Biokhimija 33, (1968), 1245 FELTER, S., A . J . C . STAHL, Bull. Soc. Chim.biol. 52, (1970), 75 HAROLD, F . M . , R. L. HAROLD, J.Bacteriol. 89, (1965), 1262 KULAEV, I . S . , T . P . AFANASIEVA, M. P. BELIKDVA, Biokhimija 32, (1967), 539 KULAEV, I . S . , I. A. KRASHE NINNIKO V, T . P . AFANASIEVA, Doklady AN USSR 190, (1970a), 1238 KULAEV, I . S . , T . P . AFANASIEVA, Doklady AN USSR 192, (1970b), 668 LINEWEAVER, H., D. BURK, J.Am.Chem.Soc. 56, (1934), 658

61 MUHAMMED, A . , A. RODGERS, D. E. HUGHES, J . Gen. Microbiol. 20, (1959), 482 STEVENENCK, J . van, Biochemistry 5, (1966), 1998 WILLIAMS, R . J . P . , "The Enzymes", Acad. P r e s s , N . Y . , 1, (1959), 391

62

i s expressed injumoles of orthophosphate formed/min. / m g of protein. The reaction mixture contained: tris+maleate buffer, 2X10~2M; MNCL^, 3X10~ 3 M; polyphosphate, n=290, 2xlO" 3 (P); 0. lmg of protein; water to 0. 5ml. The enzyme activity was measured after 5min. incutation at 37®.

Fig. 2. The effect of KC1 on the activity of polyphosphatase. The reaction mixture contained: tris+maleate buffer pH 7 . 1 , 2xlO" 2 M; MnCl2, 3 x l 0 " 3 M ; polyphosphate, 2 x l 0 " 3 M (P); KC1 in various concentrations; protein, 0. lmg; water to 0. 5ml.

Metdlion concentration,

M.—

Fig. 3. The dependence of reaction rate on polyphosphate concentration. The reaction mixture contained: tris+maleate buffer pH 7 , 1 , 2 x l 0 " 2 M ; MnClg, 3X10" 3 M; protein, 0. lmg. The total volume was 0. 5ml.

63

-VKm

J/S

-

Fig. 4. The effect of various metal ion concentrations on the enzyme activity. The incubation mixture contained: tris+maleate buffer pH 7,1, 2 x 1 0 - % ; polyphosphate, 2xlO" 3 M(P); protein, 0. lmg; water to 0. 5ml.

Fig. 5. The effect of various metal ions on the enzyme activity. The incubation mixture contained: tris+maleate bu._ -r pH 7,1, 2X10"^M; MnCl2, 2X10"3M; polyphosphate, 2xl0~ 3 M(P); various concentrations of metal ions; protein, 0. lmg; water to 0. 5ml.

Metal ion concentration, M.—

Fig. 6. The effect of various metal ions on the enzyme activity. The incubation mixture was the same as described in Fig. 5.

Lomonosow State University, Moscow

G.I. KONOSHENKO, A.M. UMNOV, I. S. KULAEV CHARACTERIZATION OF NEUROSPORA CRASSA POLYPHOSPHATE PHOSPHOHYDROLASES

Polyphosphatases hydrolyzing high-polymeric inorganic polyphosphates to orthophosphate have been reported in some microorganisms (1-6). However, the enzyme properties were studied in details only in Corinebacterium xerosis (3), Aerobacter aerogenes (4) and more recently in yeasts (6). In addition it was shown (4) that cells of A. aerogenes contain also an enzyme splitting tripolyphosphate specifically. No comparable data appear to be available for any polyphosphatase in Neurospora crassa. Indirect data on existence of polyphosphatase activity in this microorganism were obtaind recently in our laboratory (8). This paper deals with the occurence of the polyphosphatases in the wild type of Neurospora crassa Abbott 4A. It presents also some properties of the enzymes studied. It was shown that cell-free extract of N. crassa has the activities of enzymes which catalyse the hydrolysis of high-polymeric polyphosphates (n=30-290) and tripolyphosphate to orthophosphate (7). The pH optimum for both reactions was 7,2. The studies of the effects of various agents on the reaction 2+

rate revealed the necessity of Mg -ions. The addition of EDTA into incubation medium appreciably decreased the activity of the enzymes. Experiments were performed to determine the effect of various ions on the activities studied. 2+ The optimal concentration of Mg for both reactions is approximately 1 (J.M, as shown in Fig. 1. Moreover, hydrolysis of high-polymeric polyphosphates is stimulated by K + -ions (Fig. 2). The optimal concentration of K + is about 100 ¿iM. This fact is in accordance with the properties reported by HAROLD (4) for polyphosphatase from A. aerogenes. The experiments with equal molar concentrations of different polyphosphates demonstrated that the chain length of polyphosphate does not affect the stimulatory action of K + and Mg^+ on the polyphosphatase activity. The effect of IT1" is

66

sufficiently specific. For instance ions of Na + cannot replace the K + -ions. Furthermore, ions of K+ do not stimulate the tripolyphosphatase activity and in some cases they even inhibit the enzyme. The two enzymes studied-tripolyphosphatase and polyphosphatase-also differ in the sensitivity to the inhibitory action of NaF. So, fluoride (100 M) completely inhibited the former and more moderately affected the latter enzyme which retained 52 % of the initial activity. The results presented here clearly demonstrate that mycelial extracts of N. crassa contain two enzymes catalyzing the splitting of polyphosphates to orthophosphate. The two enzymes differ in substrate specificity. Recent papers of FELTER et al. (6) concerning the occurence of polyphosphatases in yeast Saccharomyces cerevisiae reported that the yeast cells contained only one enzyme catalyzing the hydrolysis of both high-polymeric polyphosphates and tripolyphosphate. It appears, that the authors did not select the proper conditions allowing to divide the two activities. The existence of two enzymes in N. crassa is confirmed also by the fact that these two activities differ in their behaviour in the course of culture growth. The results are presented in the Fig. 3 and indicate that the maxima of the two activities do not coincide. As it was shown recently in our laboratory by means of analytical disc electrophoresis on polyacrylamidegel, tripolyphosphatase and polyphosphates represent two different enzyme proteins. The localization of enzyme activities on the gel was assayed by means of procedure described by TO NO and KDRNBERG (9). The results of such reparation a r e reproduced in Fig. 4. The polyphosphatase band (A) does not coicide with the bands of the tripolyphosphatase (B) and pyrophosphatase (C). Joint development (D) of the three activities reveals three separate bands. The studies of localization of the enzymes investigated in the cells of N. crassa (the results will be reported elsewhere) demonstrated that polyphosphatase is localized on the outside of plasma membrane together with the high-polymeric polyphosphates. The tripolyphosphatase is localized mainly inside the mitochondria. The question arises about what role is played by tripolyphosphatase in mitochondria. This matter is under investigation. Based on all the data obtained we concludes that the mycelia of N. crassa, contain two enzymes hydrolyzing polyphosphates to orthophosphate. The K + -activated polyphosphatase localized on the outside of plasma membrane hydrolyses high-polymeric polyphosphates alone. The tripoly-

67 phosphatase localized inside the mitochondria hydrolyses tripolyphosphate specifically and is not identical to pyrophosphatase. The existence of the latter enzyme in microorganisms suggests a specific role of tripolyphosphate in the transformation of phosphorus and energy in these organisms.

REFERENCES (1)

KRE3HNAN, P. S., Arch. Biochem. Biophys. 37, (1952), 224

(2)

KRISHNAN, P. S., V. BAJAJ, Arch. Biochem. Biophys. 42, (1953), 174

(3)

MUHAMMED, A., A. RODGERS, D. E. HUGHES, J. Gen. Microbiol. 20, (1959), 482 HAROLD, R . L . , F.M. HAROLD, J.Bacteriol. 89; (1965), 1262 SOUZU, H., Arch. Biochem. Biophys. 120, (1967), 338 FELTER, S., G. DIRHEIMER, J. -P. EBEL, Bull. Soc. Chim. Biol.

(4) (5) (6)

52, (1970), 437 (7)

KULAEV, I . S . , G.I. KDNOSHENKO, Biochimya (in press) 1971

(8)

KULAEV, I . S . , USSR I. A. KRASHENINNIKOV, Akad. Nauk 190, (1970), 1238 T. P. AFANASJEVA, Dokl.

(9)

TONO, H., A. KORNBERG, J. Biol. Chem., 242, (1967), 2375

tripo/yphosphaiase

Fig. 1. Effect of Mg 2 + -ions on the activity of polyphosphatase and tripolyphosphatase. 1.5 (imoles

IO

Mg++—
W SM

Fig. 7. Vca inflow/Vca outflow dependence from (free Ca 2 + inside)"! at two different Mg2+ concentrations.

Department of Biochemistry, State University Leningrad

N. S. PANTELEEVA 0 1 8 EXCHANGE REACTION AS A METHOD IN THE STUDY OF THE TRANSPORT OF PHOSPHORYL GROUPS FROM ATP TO MYOSIN

Introduction During ATP hydrolysis by purified myosin, H-meromysin and actomyosin in the 18 medium, enriched by H_0 exchange reaction takes place between the P. 1 18 released and the HgO of the medium (1-4). There is good evidence that this reaction occurs at an intermediate stage in hydrolysis, supposedly in the stage of phorphorylated protein. This reaction has been termed the "intermediate 18 0 exchange". Simultaneously, "direct exchange" or "medium exchange" occurs when P. is added to the medium or released as a result of ATP hydrolysis. The proportion of direct exchange under similar conditions is negligible (5, 6). 18 In this communication, the method of 0

exchange reactions has been used

for studying the role of myosin functional groups in the formation of the ATPase reaction intermediate. Methods Myosin was prepared from rabbit skeletal muscle (7); H-meromyosin, by tryptic digestion of myosin (8). Myosin modification was carried out by treating the protein with specific reagents. For the binding of sulfhydryl groups, pCMB and NEM

(9) were used, for aminogroups - TBS (10), for carboxyl groups - pNTP

(11) and for imidazol groups - DEPC (12). As a criterion for the modification, an alteration of Mg + + - ATPase activity served. Reagent concentrations leading to activation of ATPase ("activating concentrations") and to its inhibition ("inhibiting concentrations") were used. Since myosin precipitates when treated with DEPC, H-meromyosin was used for binding imidazol groups. 18 The ATP hydrolysis was carried out in an enriched H o 0 medium under conditions 18 favourable to the intermediate 0 exchange (6,13). P. was isolated in the form 1)

Abbreviations: pCMB, p-chloromercuribenzoate; NEM, N-ethylmaleimide; TBS, 2.4. 6-trinitrobenzenesulphonate; pNTP, p-nitrothiophenol; DEPC, diethylpyrocarbonate.

132 of Ba phosphate. The 0

18

content was determined mass spectrometrically; the

oxygen of the phosphates and medium was transformed into C0 2 form by the use of the guanidine hydrochloride reaction (14). Results and discussion As seen in the table, the 0

18

exchange reaction decreases against control with

both the activating and inhibiting concentrations of the reagents binding the different functional groups of myosin molecule. As a rule, 0

18

exchange was

decreased even when the highest activation of Mg -ATPase was obtained. ++

Thus, first of all, we should note the presence of a nonspecific uncoupling of the 18 hydrolytic and the 0 exchange reactions after treatment of myosin with modifiers of different nature. However, the mechanisms of such uncoupling may be essential different for each case. If we work from the hypothesis that the phosphorylmyosin intermediate is capable of exchanging oxygen with the medium, then the sequence of ATP hydrolysis and 0 18 exchange may be presented as the following simplified scheme:

Myosin—X + ATP

Myosin

.ADP 0

16"

X—P—0

(1) H20 W

Myosin'^

..ATP (2)

Jl5) Myosin-X + ADP + Pi

\016-

(3)|+H 2 0 1 8 /ADP Myosin-' N c - f ^ = 0 1 6 + H z 0 16 \016"

At point X we may put any group (- SH, - NHg, - COOH, imidazol) to which binding of phosphoryl residues may be expected (reaction 2). According to this scheme, the P. labeling should be determined by the time of the reversal of 18 reaction 3. The change in the value of 0 exchange should reflect the change in the properties of the phosphorylated protein. Let us consider the effects of pNTP and TBS on myosin. It is known that the nucleophilic reagent pNTP attacks

133 Table THE INFLUENCE OF THE BINDING OF ACTIVE GROUPS OF MYOSIN ON MG ++ -ATPASE ACTIVITY AND ON 0 1 8 EXCHANGE REACTION IN "ACTIVATING" AND "INHIBITING" CONCENTRATIONS OF REAGENTS Active Group

Sulfhydryl

Sulfhydryl

Amino

Carboxyl

Imidazol

1)

Reagent

pCMB

NEM

TBS

pNTP

DEPC

Amount of Bound Reagent Mole • 10°^ g protein

ATPase Activity

Exchange 0 Reaction

% Against Control

2.2

200'

129

4. 3

400

52

6. 0

40

25

1.3

100

81

1.9

200

56

3. 8

50

50

1.2

486

69

2.0

534

59

2.5

786

48

12.4

876

24

0. 5

300

102

1.0

126

72

2.2

78

59

328

87

100

278

56

200

183

35

B01»

DEPC equivalents per mole H -meromyosin.

the acylphosphate and acylthioether bonds, forming a covalent complex with carboxyl groups of myosin (15,16). The amount of NTP-binding is highest in the presence of ATP and Mg + + (specific binding), where, as is expected, the reactive 18 myosin-phosphate complex is formed. The inhibition of 0 exchange (by 30-40%) 18 under such specific binding testifies to the participation in the 0 exchange reaction of myosin carboxyl groups phosphorylated in ATP hydrolysis. However,

134

with low concentration of pNTP, an increase of ATP decay, parallel with the 18

0

exchange inhibition was observed. One may suppose that in the presence of

NTP-myosin, direct hydrolysis of ATP by way of binding of water elements to an enzyme-substrate complex predominates (see scheme, reaction 5). The blocking of carboxyl groups may be considered as a depreciation of hydrolysis, uncoupling it from the phosphorylation. Another mechanism may be expected in the case of the action of TBS on myosin. The myosin molecule in the active center region of ATPase has two lysyl residues, whose aminogroups can rapidly and specifically react with TBS (17,18). According to our data, the joining of TBS to even one of these groups leads to a fivefold ++ 18 increase in Mg -ATPase activity and a simultaneous decrease in the 0 exchange reaction by 40 %. With further growth of the bonded NHg groups, ATPase activity rapidly increases, and the oxygen exchange under the same conditions decreases. If X in such a scheme is replaced with an NHg-group, then blocking of the latter will lead to depression of hydrolysis in reaction 4. Since, on the contrary, hydrolysis is accelerated many times, it may be supposed that the aminogroup itself does not take part directly in binding the phosphate residue. Most probably the blocking of aminogroups in the neighborhood of the active center, or possibly in the allosteric center, forms favourable steric conditions for rapid formation and decay of the phosphorylated intermediate and thus diminishes the time of its existence (18). The latter stimulates hydrolysis in reaction 18 4 and leads to a decrease in 0 exchange reaction in the 3rd stage (see scheme). The action of TBS is similar to the action of the physiological modifier of actin. The latter, as is known, increases Mg + + -ATPase activity of myosin by 5 - 20 18

times, simultaneously decreasing the value of intermediate 0

exchange by

30 - 35 % (6.13). The similarity of the action of these two substances, differing substantially in nature, is caused by the fact that a similar catalytically active conformation of the active center is formed under the influence of both actin and TBS. The affect of pCMB, NEM and DEPC on myosin ATPase and oxygen exchange in its nonspecific aspect is similar to the effect of pNTP and TBS. So far nothing definite can be said concerning the concrete mechanism of their influence. 18

Study of intermediate 0

exchange in combination with the method of chemical

modification enables us to obtain information concerning the properties of the intermediate formed in the stationary phase of ATP hydrolysis by myosin and concerning the possible paths of energy transport from ATP to contractile proteins.

135 Summary The role of functional groups of myosin ATPase (EC 3. 6 . 1 . 3.) in the formation of the intermediate of ATPase reaction was studied, employing the methods of 18 0 exchange reaction and chemical modification. Effects were discovered, both specific and nonspecific, of modifiers of various nature on A T P a s e activity and 18 on "intermediate 0

exchange" catalyzed by myosin in the process of ATP

hydrolysis.

REFERENCES (1)

KOSHLAND, D. E . , H. M. LEVY, In: The Biochemistry of Muscle Contraction. Ed. J . GERGELY, New York, (1967), 87

(2)

BOYER, P. D . , In: The Biochemistry of Muscle Contraction. Ed. J . GERGELY, New York, (1964), 94

(3)

PANTELEEVA, N. S . , Izv. AN USSR, ser. biol. 4 (1968), 565

(4)

PANTELEEVA, N. S . , Second All-Union Biochem. Confer. Tashkent, 1969. P r e c i s of Reports of Symposium, p. 253. Pub. FAN, Uzbekistan SSR (1969)

(5)

SWANSON, J . R . , R. G. YOUNT, Biochem Z. 345 (1966), 395

(6)

I LIN, L. A . , N.S. PANTELEEVA, Tzitologiya 9 (1967), 553

(7)

IVANOV, 1.1., V. A. YURYEV, Biokhimiya i Patobiokhimiya Myshts, Medgiz, Moscow - Leningrad (1961)

(8)

SZENT-GYORGYI, A . , Arch. Biochem. Biophys. 42 (1953), 305

(9)

KU LEVA, N . V . , N.S. PANTELEEVA, Vestn. Leningrad State Univ. s e r . biol. 3 (1968), 123

(10)

KULEVA, N . V . , N.S. PANTELEEVA, E . A . KARANDASHOV, Biokhimiya, 35 (1970), 42

(11)

KULEVA, N . V . , A. MÜHLRAD, N.S. PANTELEEVA, Biokhimiya, in p r e s s

(12)

PANTELEEVA, N. S . , N.V. KULEVA, E . A . KARANDASHOV, in p r e s s

(13)

LEVY, H . H . , N. SHARON, E. LINDEMANN, D . E . KOSHLAND, J . Biol. Chem. 235 (1960), 2628

(14)

ILIN, L. A . , Vestn. Leningrad State Univ. Ser biol. 3 (1966), 85

(15)

KITAGAWA, S . , K. CHIANG, Y. TONOMURA, Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 82 (1964), 83

(16)

KUBO, S . , N. KINOSHITAL, Y. TONOMURA, J . Biochem. (Tokyo) 60 (1966), 476

(17)

TOKUYAMA, H . , Y. TONOMURA, J . Biochem. (Tokyo) 62 (1967), 456

(18)

TOKUYAMA, H . , Ann. Rep. Biol. Works, 14 (1966), 1

Animal Biochemistry Department, Lomonosov State University, Moscow

N. P. MESHKOVA THE PHOSPHORYLATED DERIVATIVES OF HISTIDINE-CONTAINING DIPEPTIDES: SYNTHESIS AND PHYSIOLOGICAL ROLE

Histidine-containing dipeptides, carnosine and anserine are specific components of skeletal muscles. Analysis of their effect on the processes of oxidative metabolism of muscle tissue has revealed these two compounds to facilitate the coupling of oxidation and phosphorylation, the maintenance of the structure of mitochondria and the increase of the energy level of high-energy phosphorous compounds (phosphocreatine). These facts indicate that in the presence of dipeptides the content of ATP in the sample should be higher. One of the reasons for higher ATP content could be a slower rate of ATP hydrolysis in the presence of carnosine and anserine. A possibility of phosphorylation of dipeptides in the course of biological oxidation could not be ruled out either. In the present report we describe the results of a study of the effect of dipeptides from skeletal muscles, carnosine and anserine, and also imidazole and their N-phosphorylated derivatives on ATPase activity of myosin. Experiments were carried out with pigeon breast muscle myosin at an optimal ATP concentration of 2 - 1 0 " 3 M and that of C a 2 + - 4 . 1 0 ~ 3 M in Tris-buffer pH 7, 5. Quantity of protein depended on the activity of the enzyme and was from 0.15 to 0. 5 mg/ml; time of incubation - 2-3 minutes. Phosphorylated derivatives of imidazole compounds were obtained by treating the latter with POClg in alkali. Depending on alkalinity of the medium mono-and diphosphorylated derivatives of imidazole can be prepared. If phosphorylation is performed at pH 13 monophosphorylimidazole is synthetized and under milder conditions (pH 11) - symmetrical diphosphorylimidazole. As has been reported earlier, free carnosine and anserine a s well a s imidazole do not affect myosin ATPase activity. Our data do not contradict those in the literatur. PETUSHKOVA and BOCHARNIKOVA reported carnosine to produce an inhibiting effect on myosin ATPase only at substrate inhibition. AVENA and BOWEN observed an activating effect of carnosine during incubation of myosin in the

138 medium of low ionic strength and in the absence of C a 2 + ions. The authors used the conditions similar to ours and addition of carnosine did not cause activation of ATPase. The experiments made by us with the phosphorylated derivatives of imidazole, carnosine and anserine have shown them to have an inhibiting effect. Trying to clear out the effect of different concentrations of phosphorylimidazole on the activity of the enzyme we have found a direct relationship between the degree of inhibition and the ratio of the quantities of added monopnosphorylimidazole and protein. The higher the phosphorylimidazole/protein ratio the greater is the degree of inhibition (Fig. 1). A great difference was revealed between the effect of mono- and diphosphorylimidazole on the enzymatic activity of myosin. The inhibiting action of monophosphorylimidazole is always considerably higher than that of diphosphorylimidazole and has a competitive character (Fig. 2). The effect of diphosphorylimidazole is non-competitive (Fig. 3). It was also noted that the inhibitory effect of phosphorylated derivatives of imidazole depends on the specific activity of the enzyme. At higher specific activity the inhibiting effect was more pronounced. (Fig. 4) We suggested that for the competitive inhibition of ATPase activity of myosin by phosphorylated derivatives of imidazole the presence of a phosphoryl residue and free tertiary nitrogen in imidazole ring is required. To verify this suggestion experiments were carried out with the phosphorylated derivatives of carnosinemonophorylcarnosine, in which only one nitrogen atom of the imidazole ring was phosphosphorylated, and with triphosphorylcarnosine in which both nitrogen atoms in the imidazole ring and also the amino group of the (3 -alanine residue were phosphorylated (Fig. 5). It turned out that it is only monophosphorylcarnosine that produces an inhibiting effect on ATPase activity. ATPase cannot be inhibited by triphosphorylcarnosine. Monophosphorylcarnosine as well as monophosphorylimidazole causes a competitive inhibition of myosin ATPase (Fig. 6). The detailed mechanism of enzymatic splitting of ATP and the structure of myosin active centre is still the subject of intensive investigation. TONOMURA et.al. offered a model of the myosin-ATP enzyme-substrate complex, having studied the kinetics of enzymatic hydrolysis of ATP by myosin and the chemical structure of the globular portion of myosin. These authors believe that the ATP molecule binds myosin at several sites. The amino group of adenine binds with a unidentified

139

group of myosin, ribose - with the NH -peptide bond of prolyl-lysine, (3- and H-phosphate residue bind via Ca with the asparagine residue. Besides the terminal phosphate group binds with the SH-group, and, possibly, with the arginine residue (Fig. 7). Taking into consideration that only the monophosphoryl derivatives of imidazole compounds cause a competitive inhibition of the enzyme, that free imidazole compounds have no effect on the activity and that diphosphorylimidazole causes irregular and non-competitive inhibition of the process, the mechanism of inhibition of ATPase by myosin can be presented in the following way. Monophosphorylimidazole and monophosphorylcarnosine compete with ATP for theactivesite of the enzyme, the free nitrogen atom of imidazole ring binding with active site on the place of amino group of adenine, the phosphoryl residue replaces the terminal phosphate group of ATP. Naturally, the rate of cleavage of ATP thereby decreases. Inhibition of ATPase of myosin caused by diphosphorylimidazole is much less and of non-competitive nature. This way be associated with its effect on allosteric site of the enzyme. One of such sites may be a fragment of polypeptide chain containing histidine. Diphosphorylimidazole is a potent phosphorylating agent, and it may phosphorylate amino acid residues and first and foremost the imidazole group of histidine. This may lead to the conformational changes in the active site of myosin and thereby brings about changes in its enzymatic activity. This hypothesis agrees with the data on dependence of the degree of inhibitory effect on the specific activity of the enzyme. Lower inhibitory effect of monophosphorylcarnosine as compared to that of monophosphorylimidazole can be explained by the larger size of its molecule; it can hinder the formation of myosin-monophosphorylcarnosine complex or E ~ P + ADP i/+ E ~ P + H20 - E + Pi +

Na

(1) (2)

This reaction is inhibited by ouabain in high concentrations only. The initial step is followed by a K + activated, ouabain-sensitive dephosphorylation step POST (39).

155

A K + activated, ouabain-sensitive phosphatase activity, which hydrolyses acetylphosphate and p-nitrophenylphosphate, has been demonstrated in Na-K ATPase preparations from a variety of tissues HASHIUCHI (39a). Since no 32 labelling of ATP occurs on incubation of the system with P-acetylphosphate, there is a possibility that this step actually consists of two steps: E~ P -

*

E - P + H20

E- P

(3) E + Pi

(4)

The phosphorylated complex appears to be an acylphosphate, since it is hydrolyzed by NH„OH, molybdate and acylphosphatase HO KEN et al. (40), BADER, SEN, 32 POST (41). Reaction of peptic fragments of the P-phosphorylated complex with tritium-labelled N-(n-propyl) hydroxylamine yields a radioactive hydroxamate, which has been positively identified by comparison with synthetic compounds KAHLENBERG, GALSWORTHY, HO KIN (42). The acylphosphate is L-glutamyl-phosphate. A model, incorporating current insights into the Na-K ATPase mechanism, is shown in Fig. 16ALBERS, KDVAL, SIEGEL (43). The circle is the cell membrane carrying six pump sites in different stages of activity. At 1. Na+ activated phosphorylation takes place with the enzyme in the "cis"-form, i. e. with the cation binding sites pointing to the cytoplasm and binding Na+ ions. The phosphorylated enzyme is rapidly converted (2) into the "trans"-form, with the cation binding sites pointing extracellularly. In the presence of K + exchange of Na+ for K + ions on the binding sites takes place, while reaction 3 activates the hydrolytic step (4). This tep makes the "trans" enzyme less stable, which then reverts to the "cis"-form (reaction 5). The cycle is completed when Na+ displaces K + from the "cis"-enzyme (reaction 6). This concludes our survey of the properties, occurrence, function and mechanism of the Na-K ATPase cation transport system. It has a crucial physiological function in three types of system: 1. single cell systems: maintenance of cation gradients and coupled transport of metabolites. 2. excitatory systems: maintenance and restoration of cation gradients, required for passive cation movements during excitation. 3. secretory systems: sodium pump required for isotonic water-electrolyte movement, often with coupled transport of other substances.

156 In its study the disciplines of biochemistry, physiology, biophysics, morphology and pharmacology all interact to contribute what may be called the molecular biology of active cation transport. Much has been learned since the discovery of the Na-K ATPase system, yet, much still remains to be elucidated!

REFERENCES (1)

SKOU, J . C . , Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 23 (1957), 394

(2)

SKOU, J . C . , Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 42, (1960), 6

(3)

BONTING, S. L . , In: E. E. BITTAR (Ed. ), Membranes and Ion Transport, Wiley, New York, 1, (1970), 286

(4)

BONTING, S. L . , L. L. CARAVAGGIO, N. M. HAWKINS, Arch. Biochem. Biophys., 101, (1963), 47

(5)

BAKKEREN, J . A . J . M . , S. L. BONTING, Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 150 (1968), 460

(6)

BONTING, S . L . , L. L. CARAVAGGIO, M. R. CANADY, N.M. HAWKINS, Arch. Biochem. Biophys., 106, (1964), 49

(7)

BONTING, S . L . , Comp. Biochem. Physiol., 1/7, (1966), 953

(8)

BONTING, S . L . , N.M. HAWKINS, M . R . CANADY, Biochem. Pharmacol., JUi, (1964), 13

(9)

BONTING, S . L . , K A . SIMON, N.M. HAWKINS, Arch. Biochem. Biophys., 95, (1961), 416

(10)

HAFKENSCHEID, J . C. M . , S . L . BONTING, Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 151, (1968), 204

(11)

HAFKENSCHEID, J . C . M . , S . L . BONTING, Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 178, (1969), 128

(12)

BONTING, S. L . , L. L. CARAVAGGIO, N. M. HAWKINS, Arch. Biochim. Biophys., 98, (1962), 413

(13)

BONTING, S . L . , L. L. CARAVAGGIO, Arch. Biochim. Biophys., 101, (1963), 37

(14)

POST, R . L . , C . R . MERRITT, C . R . KINSOLVING, C.D. ALBRIGHT,

(15)

DUNHAM, E . T . , J . M . GLYNN, J . Physiol., 156, (1961), 274

(16)

BONTING, S . L . , Invest. Ophthalmol., 4, (1965), 723

(17)

HAFKENSCHEID, J . C . M . , S . L . BONTING, Comp. Ciochem. Physiol. (1971, in press)

(18)

CORRIE, W . S . , S . L . BONTING, Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 120, (1966), 91

(19)

HARRIS, E . J . , J . Physiol., 193, (1967), 455

J . Biol. Chem., 235, (1960), 1796

157 (20)

SJODIN, R . A . , L . A . BEAUGE, J . Gen. Physiol., 52, (1968), 389

(21)

NÖDA, K . , Kurume Med. J . , 15, (1968), 51

(22)

KUIJPERS, W . , S. L. BONTING, Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 173_, (1969), 477

(23)

KUIJPERS, W . , S. L. BONTING, Pflügers A r c h . , 320, (1970), 348

(24)

LEAF, A . , J . ANDERSON, L . B . Page, J . Gen. Physiol., 41, (1958), 657

(25)

LEAF, A . , L . B . PAGE, J . ANDERSON, J . Biol. Chem., 234, (1959), 1625

(26)

BONTING, S. L . , M. R. CANADY, Amer. J . Physiol., 207, (1964), 1005

(27)

HERRMANN, I . , H . J . PORTIUS, K. R E P K E , Arch. Exptl. Pathol. Pharmakol., 247, (1964), 1

(28)

FRAZIER, H . , E. F . DEMPSEY, A. LEAF, J . Gen. Physiol., 45, (1962), 529

(29)

BOWER, B . F . , Fed. P r o c . , 22, (1963), 445

(30)

BOWER, B . F . , Nature, 204, (1964), 786

(31)

RIDDERSTAP, A. S . , S. L. BONTING, Amer. J . Physiol., 216, (1969a), 547

(32)

RIDDERSTAP, A. S . , S. L. BONTING, Amer. J . Physiol., 217, (1969b), 1721

(33)

DIAMOND, J . M . , J . Gen. Physiol., 48, (1964a), 1

(34)

DIAMOND, J . M . , J . Gen. Physiol., 48, (1964b), 15

(35)

KAYE, G . I . , H.O. WHEELER, R. T . WHITLOCK, N. LANE,

(36)

DIAMOND, J . M . , W.H. BOSSERT, J . Cell B i o l . , 37, (1968), 694

(37)

FAHN, S . , R . W . ALBERS, G . J . KOVAL, Science, 145, (1964), 283

(38)

SWANSON, P . D . , J . Neurochem., 15, (1968), 1159

(39)

POST, R. L . , In: J . JÄRNEFELT (Ed.) Regulatory Functions of

J . Cell B i o l . , 30, (1966), 237

Biological Membranes, Elsevier, Amsterdam, 1_(1968), 173 (39a)

HASHIUCHI, Y . , Nara Igaku Zasshi,

(40)

HOKIN, E., Proc. L.Natl. BADER, H . A . , 118, (1966),

(41) (42)

1J}, (1967), 469

P . S . SASTRY, . GALSWORTHY, A. YODA, Acad. Sei. U . S .P, . R 54,(1965), 177 K. SEN, R. L. POST, Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 106

A L B E R S , R . W . , G . J . KOVAL, G . J . SIEGEL, Mol. Pharmacol., 4, (1968), 324

158

Fig. 1. Effect of pretreatment of urea on ATPase activities in Escherichia coli.

Fig. 2. pH-Activity curves for Na-K ATPase and Mg ATPase ATPase for lens epithelium.

159

tia-KATPase

6-0-

o i Mg ATPase

Fig. 3. Mg-activation curves for Na-K ATPase and Mg ATPase for rat liver.

3

4

5

m moles/l

6

Mg2+

Fig. 4. Na -activation curve for Na-K ATPase from herring gull salt gland. 20

40

60 80 100 mmoks/l Na

I

I

I

125

1

150

1—

-K m - J.5mmoles/l

5

J

10

L

15 20 25 mmo/es/l K

Fig. 5. K-activation curve for Na-K ATPase from herring full salt gland. 30

35

40

160 Piso Spiny Dogfish 6.83 Sand Shark 6.70

Fig. 6. Effect of ouabain on Na-K ATPase from shark rectal gland. Inhibition at concentrations of 10 - 7 M and higher, slight stimulation at 10' 9 -10-8 M. co 3 8 Negative log molar ouabain

1

1

1

7

6 ' 5 concentration

1

1

1

1

7M Eryfhrophieine —

5x10 -

5*10~?M Ouabain

•S -8 I 10~4M Eryfhrophieine

I

£1

A

\

4

10~ M Ouabain

-

1

1

10

15 20 25 mmolesll K

30

35

-

40

Fig. 7. Reversal of ouabaininhibition by K + ions for NaK ATPase from rabbit brain.

161 EpHheiium

Anterior capsule

Lens equaior

tens nucleus Lens bow

Fig. 8. Anatomy of the lens. '"Posterior capsule

Fig. 9. Inhibitory effect of ouabain (0. 8 x 10"4M) on °®Rb uptake by Escherichia coli.

time

(minutes)

162

Fig. 10. Schematic cross-section of the cochlea with the Na-K ATPase activity (in moles/kg dry wt/hr) of the various structure indicated by numbers.

ATPase (pIsff-5.5) (plso'54) (pko-5-5)

Fig. 11. Inhibitory effects of ouabain on Na-K ATPase activity of stria vascularis and on the cochlear potentials (ERP and CMP). 3

8 neg. log molar ouabain concentration

163

¡S -Cl •ififl 80

100

pi m oHa-K-ATPase

Fig. 12. Effect of ouabain on Na-K ATPase activity and Na+ transport in toad bladder.

4.65±0.10

• N a - t r a n s p o r t 4.58 + 0.16

8

7

6

negative tog molar ouabain

5 concentration

Fig. 13. Effect of ouabain on flow rate and ion levels of pancreatic fluid secreted by the rabbit pancreas in vitro.

164

I

r'

Fig. 15. Gall bladder epithelium in the secreting state. Explanation: 1. desmosome, 2. intercellular space, 3. narrow opening, 4. lamina propria, 5. capillary.

165

and SIEGEL (43).

Department of Biochemistry, University of Nijmegen, Nijmegen, The Netherlands

S. L. BONTING, J. J. H. H. M. DE PONT, T. D. HANSEN ANION EFFECTS ON Mg-ACTIVATED ATPase OF LIZARD GASTRIC MUCOSA

A bicarbonate-activated, thiocyanate-sensitive ATPase activity in frog gastric mucosa was reported by KASBEKAR and DURBIN (1). Since thiocyanate also inhibits the gastric acid secretion, these authors suggested that this enzyme participates directly in the sequence of reactions leading to acid secretion. In particular, they DURBIN and KASBEKAR (2) postulated that this enzyme might play a role in a chloride-bicarbonate exchange mechanism analogues to the sodium potassium exchange mechanism of the Na-K ATPase system. The inhibitory effect of SCN~ ions would then be analogous to the action of ouabain in the latter enzyme. In the course of a study of the possible role of Na-K ATPase in gastric secretion HANSEN et al. (3) we made a detailed study of the effects of bicarbonate, thiocyanate an other anions on the Mg-activated ATPase of the lizard gastric mucosa. Gastric mucosa was isolated from the lizard stomach by dissection, was homogenized and lyophilized. A 0. 02% (w/v, final concn.) homogenate was incubated for 1 hr. at 37°C in a medium of the following composition: +

2+

ATP, 2 mil; Na , 60 mil; Mg , 2 mM; Tris, 100 mM; ouabain, 0,1 mM. The pH was either 7,5 or 8,4. Various anions were present such that the total concentration was always 147 meq/l at pH 7, 5 and 97 meq/1 at pH 8,4. The medium was made inhibitory to Na-K ATPase by the absence of K + and the _4 presence of 10 M ouabain. After termination of the enzyme reaction by addition of trichloroacetic acid, the orthophosphate formed was determined by means of a molybdate-FeS04 color reagent BONTING (4). Inhibition curves were determined for thiocyanate in the presence of various anions at a constant total anion concentration. From the results for four anions shown in Fig. 1, it is apparent that in the absence of thiocyanate there are considerable differences in the Mg-ATPase activity for these various anions, the activity decreasing in the order HCO„ - > acetate =» CI" > NOo".

168 Moreover, the half-inhibition concentration for thiocyanate varies considerably with the anion. Assuming that these effects are to be ascribed to differences in the affinity of the various anions for the anion-binding sites on the enzyme, we ¿lculated the ratio of the thiocyanate concentration to the other anion at which 50% inhibition of the enzyme activity was chtained (Table 1, last column). This ratio, at which presumably half of the anion binding sites are occupied by thicyanate ions, should give a measure of the affinity of the other anion relative to that of thicyanate for the binding site: the larger the ratio, the larger its affinity. Another approach was applied by determining the enzyme activity in mixtures of chloride and each of the other anions, total anion concentration again being

Table 1 HALF-MAXIMAL INHIBITION CONDITIONS FOR Mg ATPase FROM LIZARD GASTRIC MUCOSA BY THIOCYANATE Anion

pH Maximal activity (mol/kg/hr)

HCO3-

8,4

cr

8,4

glucuronate 7,5

Concentrations at 50% inhibition SCN~ SCN" Anion ratio (mM) (meq M) „ anion x 10 J

6, 00 3, 58

8,0

89

90

6,0

91

66

3, 50 3, 44

0, 35

146,6

2,4

0,5

146,5

3,4

0,6

73,2

8,2

6,6

140,4

acetate

so "

7,5

42

7,5

3, 55

CI"

7,5

NO3-

7,5

2, 32 1, 57

20

127

47 157

total anion concn. 147 meq/1 at pH 7, 5; 97 meq/1 at pH 8,4. Figures in last column indicate affinity of anion to enzyme, value for SCN" set at 1000.

kept constant. An example of the curves is shown in Fig. 2 for the mixture chloride-acetate. In this case an activity midway between the activities for either anion alone was obtained at 8 meq/1 chloride and 139 meq/l acetate, indicating a larger affinity of chloride ions for the anion bindings sites.

169 Table 2 EFFECT OF ANION MIXTURES ON Mg ATPase FROM LIZARD GASTRIC MUCOSA Anion

pH

glucuronate 7,5 acetate

Cl mM

Concentrations at 50% activity change Anion ratio Cl / anion mM

5

142

0, 035 0, 058

8

139

7,5

9 117

69 30

8,4

70

27

so42"

7,5 7,5

NO3HCO3-

0,13 3,9 2,6

total anion concn. 147 meq/1 at pH 7, 5, 97 meq/1 at pH 8,4

The results of these experiments are summarized in Table 2. The last column gives the ratio of the concentrations of chloride and the other anion at which the activity was midway between the activities for either anion alone. This ratio should give a measure of the affinity of the other anion relative to that of chloride for the binding site: the larger the ratio, the larger its affinity. A comparison of the results from Tables 1 and 2 is presented in Table 3.

Table 3 AFFINITY OF ANIONS TO ENZYME RELATIVE TO AFFINITY OF CHLORIDE Anion

from direct substition

from thiocyanate inhibition

glucuronate

0,035

0,051

acetate

0,058

0,072

S0

0,13

0,17

Cl"

1,0

1,0

HCOg"

2,6

1,4

42

NOg

3,9

3,4

SCN"

21,3

21,3

170 There is quantitative agreement between the affinity ratios from the thiocyanateinhibition and the anion-interaction experiments. When comparing the affinity sequence to the activity sequence appearing from Fig. 1, there also turns out to be qualitative agreement between the affinity sequence and the inverse activity sequence except for the place of bicarbonate: affinity: glucuronate acetate -= 2 2S0 4 -= CL -= HCOg ^thiocyanateactivity: HCOg > S 0 4 glucuronate = acetate Cl" =-NOg~ =» thiocyanate. With regard to the place of bicarbonate, it should be kept in mind that all assays involving this anion had to be done at pH 8,4, while the other assays were done at pH 7, 5. The following conclusions seem to be warranted. The Mg ATPase of lizard gastric mucosa has anion binding sites. The enzyme activity depends on the anions occuying these sites. The stronger an anion binds to these sites, the lower the enzyme activity becomes, with exception of bicarbonate. The anions may cause a conformational change in the enzyme protein, affecting the active site. These findings suggest that the bicarbonate, thicyanate and chloride effects on this enzyme are of a different nature than those of the cations Na+ and K + and of ouabain on the Na-K ATPase system.

REFERENCES (1)

KASBEKAR, D. K., R. P. DURBIN, Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 105, (1965), 472

(2)

DURBIN, R . P . , D. K. KASBEKAR, Fed. Proc., 24, (1965), 1377

(3)

HANSEN, T. D., J. F. G. SLEGERS, J . J . H. H. M. de PONT, S. L. BONTING, (1971, in preparation)

(4)

BONTING, S. L . , In: E. E. BITTAR (ed.), Membranes and Ion Transport, Wiley, New York, 1, (1970), 257

171

Fig. 1. Inhibition of Mg ATPase from lizard gastric mucosa by thiocyanate in the presence of various anions.

Department of Biochemistry, University of Nijmegen, Nijmegen, The Netherlands

S.L. BONTING, J.H.M. WCLTGENS INORGANIC PYROPHOSPHATASE IN DEVELOPING TEETH: EFFECTS OF MAGNESIUM AND DIPHOSPHONATES

The occurrence of an inorganic pyrophosphatase in mineralizing hamster teeth was demonstrated WOLTGENS, BONTING, BIJVOET (1). There is considerable evidence that this enzyme plays a key role in the mineralization process by removing from the site of hydroxyapatite deposition inorganic pyrophosphate, which inhibits the latter process. In a study of the properties of the enzyme we determined the effects of magnesium ions and of three diphosphates. For the pyrophosphatase assay a 0, 02% (w/v, concn.) homogenate of 3-day old hamster molars was incubated for 1 hr. at 37°C in a medium of the following composition: 0,1 M TRIS pH 8, 7, 3, 3 mM inorganic pyrophosphate (PP^) and 3, 3 mM MgCl,. Fig. 1 shows the effect of Mg

2+

ions, added in a concentration range of 0-10 mM

at three different substrate concentrations (1, 6, 2, 2 and 3, 3 mM). In the absence 2+ 2+ of added Mg the enzyme showed marked activity. Addition of Mg caused an 2+ 4increased activity, which was always maximal at a Mg : P 0 0 _ molar ratio of 1. At higher Mg 2+ concentrations the activity was less than in the absence of 2+ = Mg . This indicates that the best substrate for the enzyme is Mg P 2 0 7 , less suitable is P g 0 ? 4 "

and least

suitable is MggPgO^

The chelating agent EDTA strongly inhibits the enzyme activity. When Mg 2 + was omitted from the medium nearly full inhibition was obtained with only 0,1 mM EDTA (Fig. 2). This suggests that a bivalent cation acts as a cofactor or activator of the enzyme. The inhibition by EDTA can be largely reversed by adding 5-10 mM Mg 2 + (Fig. 3). The need for a 50-100 fold excess of Mg 2 + suggests that a bivalent 2+

2-H

cation other than Mg (possibly Zn ) acts as cofactor or activator, and that ft . the excess of Mg displaces this cation from the EDTA-complex and/or favors its binding to the enzyme. Diphosphonates are structural analogues of pyrophosphate, in which the P - O - P

174

link is replaced by a P-C-P link. The following three diphosphonates were used in our study: P -X C-P EHDP - Na ethane-1-hydroxy-l, 1 diphosphonate ¿H H P -6 - P 6

MDP - Na methane-diphosphonate Cl-MDPMDP - Na dichloro methane diphosponate

51

P-C-P 2 ¿1 All three diphosponates showed an inhibitory effect on the enzyme, which did not hydrolyse them. Fig. 4 shows inhibition curves for the three compounds. The half-inhibition concentrations were about equal to the MgPgO^ 2 - substrate concentration used in the assay and were of the order of 1-3 mM. In the case of 2+

ClgMDP and MDP increase of the Mg concn. largely or completely reversed the inhibitory effect of these substances, as shown for MOP in Fig. 5. This suggests that these two diphosphonates inhibit the pyrophosphate activity primarily through complexation of bivalent cations, like in the case of the chelating agent EDTA. The diphosphonate EHDP displays a more complicated behavior. 2+ Fig. 6 shows the occurrence of clear minima in the activity curves for Mg concentrations representing Mg: (pyrophosphate + EHDP) ratios of 1. By varying the pyrophosphate concentration in the presence and absence of 1, 65 mM EHDP, while adding 2+

Mg so that all times a Mg: (pyrophosphate + EHDP) ratio of 1 was maintained, the Lineweaver -Burke plot presented in Fig. 7 was obtained. This plot indicates that under these conditions the EHDP-Mg2 -complex competitively inhibits the enzyme by competing with the (MgPgO^) substrate complex for the active site. The two complexes have apparently a nearly equal affinity for the active site, since the K m value (1 mM) and the K. value (0,7 mM) derived from Fig. 7 are approximately equal. A likely explanation for this competitive action of EHDP, which is absent in the case of the other two diphosphonates, is the presence of the OH-group on the carbon linking the two phosphoryl groups in EHDP. Apparently the P-C-P configuration is sufficiently similar to the P-O-P link in pyrophosphate to permit binding at the active site. The similarity in the inhibition curves of Fig. 4 suggests that EHDP also can inhibit through complexation of bivalent cations. The inhibitory effects of the diphosphonates is of practical significance for the

175

therapeutic treatment of conditions of abnormal calcification such as aortic calcification in rats given large dosis of vitamin Dg FRANCIS et al. (2) and dental deseases such as supragingival calculus formation MUHLEMANN (3) et al.

REFERENCES (1)

WÖLTGENS, J . H. M., S. L. BONTING, O. L. M. BIJVOET, Cale. Tiss. Res., 5, (1970), 333

(2)

FRANCIS, M.D., R.G.G. RUSSELL, H. FLEISCH, Science, 165, (1969), 1264

(3)

MÜHLEMANN, H.R., D. BOWLES, A. SCHAIT, J . P. BERNIMOULIN, Helv. Odont. Acta, 14, (1970), 31

176

Fig. 1. Effect of magnesium on pyrophosphatase activity. Noteroptimal activities at Mg : P2O17 ratio of 1.

[EDTA](mM)



Fig. 2. Effect of ethylene-diamine-tetra acetic acid (EDTA) on pyrophosphatase activity. Concentration of pyrophosphate was 3.3. mM.

177

4

6 8 [Mg2 +](mWFig. 3. Reversal of inhibitory effect of EDTA by magnesium. Concentration of pyrophosphate was 3. 3 mM, of EDTA 0.1 mM.

Fig. 5. Reversal of MDP inhibition of pyrophosphatase activity by magnesium. Concentration of pyrophosphate was 3. 3 mM.

178

£

1 S oC Fig. 6. Effect of magnesium on the inhibition of pyrophosphatase activity by EHDP.

1

0

1 2 1/s (mmol PPj . I)-*-

Fig. 7. LINEWEAVER-BURKE plot for the inhibition of pyrophosphatase activity by EHDP. Molar concentration of magnesium was kept equal to the sum of the pyrophosphate and EHDP concentration.

Forschungszentrum für Molekularbiologie und Medizin der Deutschen Akademie der Wissenschaften zu Berlin, Berlin-Buch K.R.H. REPKE, R. SCHÖN, W. SCHÖNFELD, H. J. PORTIUS1* DOES Na + + K + -DEPENDENT ATPase CONSIST OF MORE THAN ONE ENZYME ENTITY

Regarding the present state of knowledge on transport ATPase action (for reviews see SKOU (3), ALBERS (4), HOHN (5), POST and COWORKERS (6) ), progress might partially depend on additional ideas about its possible reaction mechanism for the uphill transport of sodium and potassium ions a c r o s s cell membrane. So, we asked ourselves whether or not the Na + +K + -dependent ATPase could eventually consist of more than one enzyme entity. This question occurred to us when it became evident by the work of NEUFELD and LEVY (7) and of WOODEN and WIENEKE (8) that a Na + -dependent ATPase -apparently involved in the uphill transport of sodium ions- and a K + -dependent phosphatase -apparently involved in the uphill transport of potassium ions- exist a s separately and independently working entities in the plasma membrane of certain cells. We thought it possible that in Na + +K + -dependent ATPase

(NaK)-ATPase

both

+

enzymes might interact in a concerted manner so that the initial Na -dependent transphorsphorylation from ATP to enzyme I: enzyme I+MgATP -

phosphoenzymel+ADP+Mg

(1)

++

is more or less tightly coupled by a Mg -catalyzed transphosphorlation from phosphoenzyme I to enzyme II: Mc + + phosphoenzyme I+enzyme n „ " ^ phosphoenzyme n+enzyme I

(2)

+

with the K -dependent hydrolytic reaction: K+ phosphoenzyme n - enzyme II+Pj

(3)

Reaction (1) could be catalyzed by the Na + -dependent ATPase and reactions (2) and (3) by the K + -dependent phosphatase. So, the normal phosphoryl donator for the phosphatase would be phosphoenzyme I. As well-known, however, (NaK)1)

Parts of our work reviewed here were presented in preliminary short communications (1, 2)

180 ATPase easily splits acetyl phosphate and p-nitrophenyl phosphate, too. As to the supposed transphosphorylation step (2), ROBINSON'S suggestion derived from kinetic and chemical evidence may be cited here that after the initial No + -activated formation of an acylphosphate (localized in enzyme E^) the phosphoryl group becomes transferred to a hydrolytic site called E^: [

E l

ATP

E l

~P]

-E2-P

K^[

E

3-Pj-^E

1 +

P.

ADP

This hydrolytic site could be identic with the supposed enzyme n, although ROBINSON left it open whether or not the site should be localized at the same enzyme protein as the initial acyl phosphate. In an attempt to check the question about the involvement of two enzyme proteins in transport ATPase action we used as a possibly useful tool the dialdehyde derivative of ATP which, it was hoped, could interact with an ATPase moiety, but not with a phosphatase moiety. In "ATP-dialdehyde", which was synthesized by Dr. SCHUTT in Professor LANGENs group the vicinal cis-located hydroxy groups of ribose are oxidized to aldehyde groups (Fig. 1). ATP-dialdehyde does not undergo hydrolysis by (NaK)-ATPase and does not serve as phosphoryl group donator to the enzyme protein. This can be deduced from the observation that, in contrast to ATP, the dialdehyde derivative does not reduce the steady state level of phosphoprotein obtained by incubation of the enzyme preparation with A T P - f ^ P , Mg + + and Na+ (Table 1).

Table 1

Nucleotide ATP-732P M ATP-y P + ATP ATP-jf

P + ATP-dialdehyde

"52P incorporated (cpm/U)

25, 8 13,9 24,3

Lack of effect of ATP-dialdehyde on steady state level of Na -induced phosphorylation of (NaK)-ATPase by A T P - t f 3 2 P . A T P - t f 3 2 P , ATP and ATP-dialdehyde each 0,005, Mg + + 1, Na+ 80, pH 7,4, 60 sec, 0° (concentrations in mM).

181 ATP-dialdehyde inhibits (NaK)-ATPase by a relatively slow reaction. The resulting inhibition is essentially irreversible. The same percentage of inhibition is reached whether ATP-dialdehyde was present during activity determination or present during pre-incubation only (Table 2). The chemical basis of the obseryed inhibitory effect could be the formation of a SCHIFF base between ATP-dialdehyde and an amino group shown to be present in the active centre of (NaK)-ATPase by POST and coworkers (6) (Fig. 2). That this amino gruop apparently plays an essential role in enzymic activity is suggested by the observation, originally made by PULL (9) and confirmed by us, that citraconic anhydride, an almost specific reagent for primary amino groups, likewise inhibits (NaK) -ATPase.

Table 2 LACK OF REVERSIBILITY OF (NaK)-ATPase INHIBITION BY ATP-DIALDEHYDE Special conditions 1 hr incubation in presence of ATP alone or ATP plus ATP-dialdehyde

Inhibition % 90

1 hr pre-incubation in presence of ATP alone or ATP plus ATP-dialdehyde. After removal of ATPdialdehyde excess 1 hr incubation in presence of ATP

87

Common conditions: ATP and ATP-dialdehyde each 2, Mg + + 2 or 4, Na + 135, K* 5, pH 7,4, 37° (concentrations in mM).

Although ATP-dialdehyde is not used as substrate by (NaK)-ATPase, it nevertheless apparently induces a similar change of enzyme conformation a s does ATP. This becomes evident when studying the binding of the negative effector ouabain to the enzyme (Fig. 3). While in the absence of nucleotides there is only a very low ouabain binding, ATP-dialdehyde proves almost as effective a s ATP in producing ouabain affinity. On the basis of its apparently specific interaction with the ATPase, ATP-dialdehyde seemed to be suited for answering the question on the existence of a separate,

182 though normally interdependtly acting phosphatase in (NaK)-ATPase. However, after ATP-dialdehyde treatment of the enzyme preparation, K+-dependent phosphatase activity proved to be inhibited to a comparable percentage as the overall (NaK)-ATPase activity (Table 3). The result does not favour the idea that (NaK)-ATPase consists of two enzyme entities. Indeed, ATP-dialdehyde does not act as specifically as desired, since besides the K+-dependent phosphatase it also inhibits an unspecified phosphatase activity presumably independent of (NaK)-ATPase activity (Table 4). In addition to the analysis of ATP-dialdehyde enzyme interactions, we followed (NaK)-ATPase and (K)-phosphatase activities in various isolation and purification procedures and found an essentially constant ratio. Accordant with this observation, in a very recent paper HOKIN et al. 10 described, that the specific activity of

Table 3 COMPARISON OF THE INHIBITORY EFFECT OF ATP-DIALDEHYDE ON (NaK) -ATPase ACTIVITY AND (K)-PHOSPHATASE ACTIVITY Enzymic activity

Inhibition (%)

Na + + K+-dependent ATPase

68

K+-dependent Phosphatase (NPPase)

46

of Mg + + 3 and C a + + 1 at pH 7,4 and 37° for 15 min, the medium was removed and portions of the sample were incubated either with ATP 2, Mg + + 2, Na + 135, K+ 5, EGTA 0 1 or p-nitrophenyl phosphate 5, Mg + + 5, K+ 5, EGTA 0,1 at pH 7,4 and 37° for 30 min (concentrations in mM).

K + -activated p-nitrophenyl phosphatase increased in parallel with that of the (NaK) -ATPase on 30 to 50 times purification. These and other data prompted us to think about possibilities for the understanding of the peculiar ATPase and phosphatase activities of (NaK) -ATPase alternative to the conception as discussed up to now. As the result of an attempt to integrate the mass of data and ideas from literature and our own experience, we emerged with a model for the Na++K+-dependent hydrolysis of ATP and the K+-dependent hydrolysis of p-nitrophenyl phosphate by

183 one single enzyme protein (Fig. 4). Its main features are as follows. The basic assumption is that the enzyme protein may exist in form of the two conformational isomers E. and E . The E. isomer is combined with sodium ions and mayJ therefore 1 0 1

Table 4 INHIBITION OF MEMBRANE-LOCALIZED PHOSPHATASES BY ATP-DIALDEHYDE Enzymic activity (K) -phosphatase Unspecified phosphatase*' lj

Inhibition (%) 86 100

K + omitted from incubation mixture

Pre-incubation (15 min): ATP-dialdehyde 2, Mg + + 5, K + 5, pH 7,4, 37°. Incubation (1 hr): additional presence of p-nitrophenylphosphate(^) (concentrations in mM).

also be called the sodium form; its cation binding site is located at the inside of the membrane. This sodium form preferentially uses ATP, but partially also acetyl phosphate as substrate. The E q isomer is combined with potassium ions and may therefore also be called the potassium form; its cation binding site is located at the outside of the membrane. This potassium form preferentially uses p-nitrophenyl phosphate as substrate. These assumptions refer among other things to the following data. Sodium ions, in the presence of saturating K + -concentrations, accelerate the hydrolysis of acetyl phosphate and grossly depress the hydrolysis of p-nitrophenyl phosphate as shown by ROBINSON (11). Potassium ions decrease the enzyme-ATP dissociation constant NORBY and JENSEN (12). p-Nitrophenyl phosphate competitively inhibits Na++K+-dependent ATPase activity and ATP competitively inhibits I n dependent phosphatase activity, as described by BADER and SEN (13), ISRAEL and TITUS (14) or FORMBY and CLAUSEN (15). With both enzymic acitivities, the hydrolysis of the substrates proceeds through the stage of an intermediary phosphoenzyme. However, the phosphorylated group is on the Na++K+-dependent ATPase activity a hydroxylamine-sensitive carboxyl phosphate, according to HOKIN (5) a glutamyl-tf -phosphate residue, and on the

184 K + -dependent p-nitrophenyl phosphatase activity it is, according to ROBINSON (16), an unknown phosphate-carrying residue largely insensitive to hydroxylamine. Moreover, in (NaK) -ATPase activity there a r e two phosphorylated stages, according to our denotation the sodium form and the potassium form of the phosphoenzyme. Both presumably carry an acyl phosphate, but a r e apparently largely different in their conformational energy. Thus, only the sodium form of the phosphoenzyme exhibits an ADP-ATP exchange activity (6). On the basis of this model the uphill transport of Na + and K + by (NaK) -ATPase a c r o s s cell membrane can be thought to proceed a s follows. Under the catalytic action of Na + , the enzyme protein i s readily phosphorylated, which imposes a heavy conformational constraint upon the phosphoprotein E.. This enables the Na + -loaden protein to undergo a vectorial conformational change carrying the cation binding site and with it sodium from in to out. The phosphoprotein E Q thus formed releases Na + and attracts K + . K + catalyzes the hydrolysis of the phosphoprotein which presumably proceeds through the stages of bond cleavage and separation of phosphate from the enzyme phosphate addition complex. This latter stage involves a backward conformational change, carrying the cation binding site and with it potassium from out to in. The oscillating, energy-consuming conformational changes of enzyme protein, postulated to effect the vectorial cation transport, should tentatively be described in t e r m s of free energy changes. Thus, it may be permitted to speculate a little further. Fig. 5 shows a comparison of free energy diagrams for the hydrolysis of the phosphate group of those phosphoproteins which a r e thought to be intermediates of alkaline phosphatase, (K) -phosphatase or (NaK)-ATPase. The diagram for alkaline phosphatase i s based on data of WILSON and DAYAN (17), while the diagrams for the two other enzymes a r e but speculatively constructed in a preliminary attempt to relate conformational and chemical events to free energy changes and transport work. According to PECK et al. (18), the large positive value of the standard free energy change accompanying hydrolysis of the phosphoserine residue of alkaline phosphatase, +5, 5 kcal, in comparison with the value of -3, 3 kcal for phosphoserine suggests the presence of large positive honcovalent interactions between the phosphate group and the protein in the phosphoform of phosphatase. The relatively small free energy change for bond breaking, -2, 5 kcal, suggests that these interactions a r e not extensively altered during bond breaking. F o r the final step, the separation of the enzyme phosphate complex, the free energy change i s a high

185 as +8 kcal. As to the phosphoprotein intermediates of (K) -phosphatase and (NaK)ATPase, the corresponding values for bond cleavage and dissociation of the phosphate group are not available. As will be shown later, the phosphorylation of the glutamyl acid residue of (NaK)ATPase is accompanied by a conformational change which might confer on the protein a conformational energy able to do vectorial transport work. As pointed out KLOTZ et al. (19), but minors changes in structure or orientation of small groups in macromolecules are accompanied by substantial changes in free energy. The free energy changes of (NaK) -ATPase by phosphorylation with ATP (formation of

E . ~ P ) or p-nitrophenylphosphate (formation of

-P) are unknown as yet,

but the differences in enthalpy between the transition states and the initial reactants were calculated by FORMBY and CLAUSEN (20) to be 12,4 and 7, 2 kcal/mole, respectively. Thus, the transport of Na+ from in to out does not necessarily require bond cleavage, i. e. the potassium form of the phosphoprotein might carry the unchanged acyl phosphate residue. The free energy, released by K + -catalyzed bond breaking of the acyl phosphate residue with consecutive dissociation of enzyme phosphate complex, could be consumed for a backwards directed conformational change of the protein transporting K + from out to in. Summing up this part of the talk, it appears to us that the conception on the existence of both a Na + - and a K + -form of (NaK)-ATPase protein, using preferentially either ATP and acetyl phosphate or phosphate esters as substrates, makes it unnecessary to think that (NaK)-ATPase activity might involve the concerted action of more than one enzyme entity. The separately occuring and independently working Na+-dependent ATPase and K+-dependent phosphatase, as described by NEUFELD and LEVY (7) or WOODIN and WIENEKE (8), could rather be related to (NaK)-ATPase as far as having lost either the site for K + -activation or the site for Na + -activation. In our model for the transformation of chemical energy into osmotic work by (NaK) -ATPase, it is postulated that the initial reaction stages impose on the enzyme protein a conformational constraint able to do vectorial transport work. As will be shown now, the Na + -catalyzed phosphorylation of the enzyme and already the formation of the enzyme substrate complex appear to be involved in the induction of this supposed conformational constraint. As a sensitive and specific tool for evidencing the production of a conformation change accompanying those first steps of enzyme action, we used the appearance of a strong affinity for the negative enzyme effector ouabain LINDENMAYER and SCHWARTZ (21).

186 As well-known, ouabain can combine with one of the two intermediary phosphoforms of the enzyme and stabilize it against the dephosphorylating action of K + , thus interrupting the phosphorylation-dephosphorylation cycle. However, the widely accepted view (6) that the potassium form (frequently called Eg-P) attracts ouabain, is presumably not correct. This is one of the conclusions to be drawn from the following experimental observations. +

+ *

In the absence of K from the medium, Na catalyzes the phosphorylation of the enzyme protein by ATP (6), the steady state level being reached within about 60 sec (Fig. 6). Ouabain at very high concentrations suppresses the phosphorylation so that the steady state level of phosphoenzyme is reduced to that found in the absence of added Na + . However, ouabain, at the very low concentrations used in the following experiments, solely stabilizes the phosphoenzyme against the hydrolytic action of contaminating K+. Under such conditions favouring maximal phosphorylation, ATP in concentrations a s low a s 0, 02 mM induces a change in enzyme conformation a s evidenced by production of affinity for the effector ouabain (Fig. 7). ^ Compared to the rate of phosphorylation, ouabain binding to the phosphoenzyme proceeds very slowly. Apparently, it is a statistically seldom event that, at the very low effector concentrations used, an ouabain molecule in the right position for combination meets an enzyme molecule in the appropriate conformation. When Na + is replaced by Ca + + in the incubation mixture, there is, if any, but a slow phosphorylation of the enzyme by ATP (Fig. 8). Under these slowly or nonphosphorylating conditions, ATP in concentrations as low a s 0,01 mM likewise induces a change in enzyme conformation a s evidenced by production of ouabain affinity (Fig. 9). However, a comparison of the rates of ouabain binding induced by ATP, Mg ++ and Na + or by ATP, Mg ++ and Ca + + (Fig. 7 and 9) reveals that in the Ca + + system the rate is markedly lower. The tempting conclusion that, before phosphorylation, already the formation of the enzyme substrate complex may induce a change of enzyme conformation, is substantiated by the results of our experiments with ATP-dialdehyde mentioned earlier.

1)

The abrupt levelling of the ouabain binding curves at lower ATP concentrations may be assumed to be due to complete ATP hydrolysis at the time of levelling.

187 As may be recalled here, although ATP-dialdehyde is unable to phosphorylate the enzyme, it nevertheless induces ouabain binding in presence of Mg + + and Na+ as effectively as ATP (Fig. 3 and 10). Apparently, in (NaK)-ATPase as in many other proteins quaternary structure is modified when substrate is bound (19). Taken together, our observations suggest that the formation of the enzyme substrate complex induces a similar conformational change of the enzyme as the consecutive phosphorylation does or maintains. Thus, the enzyme substrate formation may contribute to the production of the conformational energy postulated to be important for the osmotic work of the enzyme. Our studies on the dissociation of the enzyme effector complex (Fig. 10) revealed the important fact, that its stability essentially depends on the presence of Na + , but is independent whether the ouabain binding conformation was induced by formation of enzyme substrate complex (with ATP-dialdehyde) or by phosphorylation (with ATP). With both nucleotides, C a + + is less effective than Na + in stabilizing enzyme ouabain complex. Furthermore, the ouabain binding induced by ATP, Mg + + , Na + is reduced to the rate obtained with Mg + + alone, if K + is substituted for Na + (Fig. 11). These observations let us assume that it is the sodium conformation of the phosphoenzyme which preferentially or solely binds ouabain. One of the puzzling features of (NaK) -ATPase discovered by SCHWARTZ et al. (21), is that ouabain binding to the enzyme can be obtained with P. and Mg + + as effectively as with ATP, Mg + + and Na + (Fig. 11). Reduction of incubation temperature reduces the rate of binding in both systems to the same extent (Fig. 12). The activation energy of binding is in both cases 25 kcal/mole. Moreover, after removal of excess ouabain, the enzyme effector complexes independently on way or phase of formation dissociate with the same rate (Fig. 13). The half life time of both complexes is about 120 min. These results suggest the conclusion that in both media ouabain becomes bound to the same enzyme conformation apparently induced or maintained by phosphorylation. As shown by POST and coworkers (6), ouabain in presence of Mg + + effects phosphorylation of the enzyme with inorganic phosphate to about the same level as that obtained with ATP, »Mg++, Na + . ALBERS and coworkers (22) described that the electrophoretic mobilities of the phosphopeptides obtained by peptic and pronase digestion of both preparations are indistinguishable and that the chemical stability of the incorporated phosphate is also similar with both phosphoproteins. Thus, we are left with the conclusion that ouabain in

188 presence of Mg ++ and P. can effect the esterification of a carboxyl group with phosphate yielding an acyl phosphate of high free energy of hydrolysis. If this conclusion should prove to be correct, the energy for this ester formation might be derived from the removal of a conformational constraint which could result from a moulding effect of ouabain on enzyme prote.in during combination in presence of Mg ++ and Pj. This standard free energy change for the interaction of the enzyme-ouabain complex was calculated by TOBIN and SEN (23) to be about 9, 5 kcal/mole suggesting a large conformational change of the enzyme. According to ALBERS et al. (24), the resulting conformational potential could eliminate the free energy difference between f r e e enzyme and phosphoenzyme and adjust the free energy potential of the system to the thermodynamic requirements of phosphorylation. Summing up this final part of the talk, we would say the following (Fig. 14). The formation of the enzyme substrate complex and the consecutive Na + -catalyzed phosphorylation result in similar changes of enzyme conformation a s evidenced by production of similar affinities to ouabain. In this way, the enzyme could gain conformational energy to be used for the vectorial work of Na + transport from in to out. In presence of Mg ++ , ouabain, due to a moulding effect on enzyme protein, is supposed to confer on the enzyme a conformational constraint, of which the energy could be used for the incorporation of inorganic phosphate into the enzyme or possibly for the phosphorylation of the carboxyl residue in the active centre. As may be added here, this synthesis does not work if Na + is present (23). Presumably, Na + by its relaxation effect on conformational constraint removes that ouabain induced conformational potential of the enzyme protein thought to supply the free energy required. Note added after the Symposium (May 10, 1971) In a very recent paper, W. BOOS and A. S. GORDON (J. Biol. Chem. 246, (1971), 621), have shown that the galactose-binding protein of E. coli exists in two forms, representing different conformational states. According to these authors, the active transport of galactose through the cell membrane would involve preferential association of galactose to the highly binding active conformer on the outside of the cell membrane and subsequent dissociation of galactose from the less binding conformer on the inside of the membrane. The energy-dependent accumulation of galactose inside the cell might be explained by an energy-dependent continuous transformation from one state to the other followed by an energy-independent

189 reversal of this reaction. Thus, the conclusion reached in the present lecture that the vectorial coupled transport of Na + and K + a c r o s s cell membrane by (NaK)-ATPase i s effected by one single enzyme entity oscillating between four anisotropic conformational states of different ionic selectivities and affinities, appears to be of more general significance.

REFERENCES (1)

SCHÖN, R . , W. SCHÖNFELD, K . R . H . REPKE, Acta biol. med. germ. 24, (1970), 61

(2)

SCHÖN, R . , W. SCHÖNFELD, K . R . H . REPKE, Acta biol. med. g e r m . , 25, (1970), 1

(3)

EXOU, J . C . , Physiol. R e v . , 45, (1965), 596

(4) ALBERS, R . W . , Ann. Rev. Biochem., 36, (1967), 727 (5) HOKIN, L. E . , J . Gen. Physiol., 54, (1969), 327 (6)

PÖ§T, R. L . , S. KUME, T. TOBIN, B . ORCUTT, A. K. SEN, J . Gen. Physiol. 54, (1969), 306

(7)

NEUFELD, A. H . , H. M. LEVA, J . Biol. Chem., 245, (1970), 4962

(8) WOODIN, A . M . , A.A. WIENEKE, Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun., 33, (1968), 558 (9)

PULL, I . , Biochem. J . , 119, (1970), 377

(10) UESUGI, S . , N. C. DULAK, J . F . DIXON, T. D. HEXUM, J . L. DAHL, J . F . PERDUE, L. E. HOKIN, J . Biol. Chem. 246, (1971), 531 (11) ROBINSON, J . D . , Arch. Biochem. Biophys., 139, (1970), 164 (12) NORBY, J . G . , J . JENSEN, Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 233, (1971), 104 (13) BADER, H . , A. K. SEN, Biochim. Biophys. Acta, U 8 , (1966), 116 (14) ISRAEL, Y . , E. TITUS, Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 139, (1967), 450 (15) FORMBY, B . , J . CLAUSEN, Z. physiol. Chem., 349, (1968), 909 (16) ROBINSON, J . D . , Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun., 42, (1971), 880 (17) WILSON, I . B . , J . DAYAN, Biochemistry, 4, (1965), 645 (18) PECK, E . J . , D.S. KIRKPATRICK, J . W . RAY, Biochemistry, 7, (1968), 152 (19) KLOTZ, M . , N. R. LANGERMAN, D. W. DARNALL, Ann. Rev. B i o c h e m . , 39, I.(1970), (20) FORMBY, B . , J . 25 CLAUSEN, Z. physiol. Chem., 350, (1969), 973 (21) LINDENMAYER, A. SCHWARTZ, Arch. Biochem. Biophys., 140, (1970), 371 (22) SIEGEL, G . J . , G . J . KOVAL, R.W. ALBERS, J . Biol. Chem., 244, (1969), 3264

190 (23) TOBIN, T . , A. K. SEN, Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 198, (1970), 120 (24) ALBERS, R . W . , G . J . KOVAL, G . J . SIEGEL, Mol. Pharmacol., 4, (1968), 324

191

HO—P~0 — P~0—P—0—CHj OH

OH

OH

NH, I Fig. 1. "ATP -dialdehyde ".

Fig. 2. Sequence of reactive groups and bonds in the primary structure of the phosphorylated third peptic fragment of the phosphorylated enzyme intermediate (POST et al. : J. Gen. Physiol. 54, 306s (1969)).

| C^ ^N

r

9,| \ CH C / ^N—

/

0

C v H

0 0 \ c^' —c H H

r-y

OH

| p-Oh 0 0=(!

0 =

HjN-

SH COOH |

NH; 12

-cooh

Ouabain bound

ADP 5

1

GTP

Irf

K'ITP

575

CTP 250

865

the substrate site of (Na+ + K+) -activated ATPase, and that binding of ATP also involves a link between the $ -phosphate group and the enzyme. The Effect of K + and Na+ on the Apparent Dissociation Constant, K' Determination of IP ^ g g on the native enzyme preparations revealed a variation of this value between 0.17 and 0. 35 fiM. Experiments in which K was added to washed enzyme preparations (contaminated with about 40 (LM. K + and 100 ¿iM Na+) revealed that K' ^

was dependent upon the K + -concentration (Fig. 3). These

observations led us to propose the formation of a K + -enzyme complex which bind ATP with a lower affinity than the potassium-free enzyme (7). According to this model the following dissociation constants were calculated: kE-ATP

JJEATP-K

=

0 =

12mM>

rKE-ATP

=

0

7mM;

kE-K

=

8 7 M M a n d

500 ¿iM ( r e f . 7).

The effect of N a + ^ g g was studied in a similar way and the results obtained are shown in Fig. 4. In contrast to what was observed for K , an increase in Na concentration tends to promote a decrease in

, the effect being highly

dependent on the K concentration. This, as well as the tendency for K' ( j i g g to reach a level independent of the K + and Na+ concentrations, can be explained by assuming 1) that there is a binding of Na + to a site on the enzyme, 2) that Na+ on this site is without influence on the affinity for ATP or, in other words, that the enzyme and enzyme-ATP complex have the same affinity for Na+, and 3) that binding of Na + excludes binding of K + to the site at which it exerts its effect on the binding of ATP. The Na+ - and K + - site might be the same site. Conclusion The results reported here are confined to what may be called the first step in the hydrolysis of ATP by (Na+ + K+) -activated ATPase. The observations that ATP will bind to the enzyme with a high affinity, in the absence of Mg, and that K +

202 affects the binding process, require a reconsideration of earlier conclusions drawn from kinetic studies concerning the enzyme-substrate-cation interaction.

REFERENCES (1)

SKOU, J . C . , Physiol. Rev., 45, (1965), 596

(2)

ALBERS, R.W., Ann. Rev. Biochem., 36, (1967), 727

(3)

HEINZ, E . , Ann. Rev. Physiol., 29, (1967), 21

(4)

WHITTAM, R . , K. P. WHEELER, Ann. Rev. Physiol., 32, (1970), 21

(5)

SKOU, J. C., C. HILBERG, Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 185, (1969), 324

(6)

COLOWICK, S . P . , F.C. WOMACK, J. Biol. Chem., 244, (1969), 774

(7)

NORBY, J. G., J. JENSEN, Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 233, (1971), 104

(8)

HANSEN, O., J. Jensen, J. G. NORBY, Nature, submitted for publ.

(9)

JENSEN, J . , J.G. NORBY, Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 233, (1971), 395

203

u

0

1

1 2

1

1 4

:

i

L 6

B/F

Fig. 1. Scatchard-type plot of a typical ATP-binding experiment (7).

Fig. 2. Relationship between binding capacity and (Na + + K*) -activity for heat-denatured preparations ( • ), and preparations partially inhibited with ouabain (o), PCMB ( a ) , NEM ( • ) or ethacrynate ( v ) . The straight line is drawn through the origin and the point (+) representing the average + SEM of 14 native preparations (unpublished).

K+ ImMI Fig. 3. The effect of K+ on the apparent dissociation constant of enzymeATP complex. The curve is calculated according to the model(7) and dissociation constants mentioned in the text.

\

0.4 k.

0

0

i

I 4

i

I 8

1

1— 12

Na + (mM)

Fig. 4. Relationship between the apparent dissociation constant of enzymeATP complex and Na+ concentration at K+ = 72 ¡i M (o) and 560 ji M (•) (unpublished).

Timiriazev Institute of Plant Physiology, USSR Academy of Sciences, Moscow

M.S. KRASAVTNA, E.I. VYSKRIBENTSEVA SOME PROPERTIES OF ATPase OF PLANT TISSUES

Unlike animal tissues the study of ATPase activity of plants has not been practised until recently so that its properties have not been agreed upon heretofore. In this connection there has been started the study of ATPases specific to functionally different plant tissues. The most of our experiments have been conducted on Cucurbita roots. An enzyme preparation was obtained by homogenation of the tissue in a five - fold volume of tris-sucrosebuffer, precipitation by ammonium sulphate and dialysis against tris-buffer or distilled water. ATPase reaction of such a preparation has an optimum activity at pH 4. 5-5 and shows less pronounced increase in activity at pH 10. To lay open the processes capable of regulating the intracellular enzyme activity, we assumed it to be inexpedient to carry out experiments under conditions of maximum enzyme activities; it is why the majority of experiments were carried out at pH 7. 2 which is approximate to the physiological conditions of the root tissues. A response of the ATPase reaction to the activators and inhibitors has been studied (Table 1). The common inhibitor of all phosphatases, viz., NaF is found to suppress enzyme activity almost completely. Of interest is also the stimulation of ATPase in the presence of DNP in the reaction mixture, a s well a s a weak inhibitory effect in the presence of NaNj. These results suggest that the hydrolysis of ATP is similar to that in mitochondria of animal cells and the utilization of energy of ATP in Cucurbita roots may occur by inverting the reaction of oxidative phosphorylation. Strophanthin - sensitive ATPase has been found in Cucurbita roots. Introduction of this inhibitor into the incubation mixture results in a 20-25 per cent suppression of ATPase reaction. Such a dependence of ATPase on strophanthin is of special interest for plant physiologists because the presence of a strophanthin-sensitive ATPase in plant tissues is so far called in question (1,2, 5). Meanwhile a strophanthin - sensitive ATPase in animal tissues is closely coupled with the

206 Table 1 ATPase ACTIVITY OF CUCURBITA ROOTS ii moles Pi Treatment 1 mg protein- h

/xmoles Pj mg protein- h

NaF 10 mM

2.10 0.20

Mg

1.62 3.89

DNP 0. 25 mM

3.31

Ca 2 + 3 mM

Treatment -

NaN, 10 mM strophanthin 0. 05 mM

1.82 1.71

2+

3 mM

3.17 Mg + Na 50 mM + K 10 mM 4.67 Mg 2+ + Na + 50 mM + K+ 10 mM + stroph. 4.04 2+

+

+

1) Homogenation and dialysis with 5 mM EOTA. The tissues were homogenized in 5 volumes of icecold tris-HCl buffer pH 7. 2 (20 mM tris, 0. 25 M sucrose) precipitated by ammonium sulphate (sat. 0. 7) and dialysed against 3 mM tris buffer pH 7. 2 Incubation mixture contains 1. 2 mM ATP, 20 mM t r i s -HC1 pH 7. 2 and other components shown in the table. The incubation time was 1 hr at 30 . During this period the reaction was linearly with time.

transport of K and Na cations through cellular membrane. And if the mechanisms of cation active transport in animal and plant tissues are the same, transport ATPases must have been especially specific to the root a s an organ specialized in uptake, transport and excretion of mineral elements. As it is evidenced by the data of Table 1, a highest activity of ATPase develops in the concurrent presence of magnesium, sodium and potassium ions. An ATPase activated by Na + and K+ is responsible for about 17-20 per cent of this activity. It is of interest that strophantin inhibits by 80 per cent just the above part of the enzyme activity. Bivalent cations stimulate ATPase considerably. Thus, a 3 mM solution of Mg ++ increases about twice the activity while the effect of the same concentration of Ca + + is weaker. Higher cation concentrations inhibit the enzyme. The ability of ATPase to be stimulated or inhibited by cations is environmentdependent. Ph is one of the factors affecting the response of ATPase to cations (Table 2).

207

Table 2 THE EFFECT OF pH ON THE ATPase SENSITIVITY TO CATIONS Treatment

^j.moles Pi pH 5.1

/

mg protein- h pH 9.0

2. 52

1.08

Mg 3 mM Mg ++ + Na+ 50 mM + K + 10 mM

3. 06 3. 52

0. 96 0. 62

Ca + + 3 mM

2. 36

1.35

-

++

The reaction mixture: 3 mM ATP, 50 mM tris and different cation.

The optimum activity of Mg ++ or (Na+ - K+) -stimulated ATPase was found to be at lower pH values than that of Ca ++ -stimulated ATPase. Thus, at pH 5.1 both Mg ++ and Na+ plus K + activate the ATPase, while at pH 9 these cations in the same concentration even inhibit the enzyme activity. Conversely, Ca-cation stimulates the reaction occurring at alkaline pH. The ion status of a tissue also affects the dependence of ATPase reaction on cations. Thus, when the 5 mm-segments of Cucurbita stem have been preliminarily held in a solution of KC1, a surface ATPase is stimulated by potassium and sodium cations whereas the enzyme activity is badly inhibited by strophanthin (Table 3). The above cations exhibit but quite different effect on the ATPase activity of segments pretreated with a solution of NaCl. In this case the "sensitivity" of the enzyme to monovalent cations must have been raised so that the same concentrations of Na+ and K + are inhibitory. Strophanthin probably hinders the interaction between the potassium excess and the enzyme, prevents its inhibitory effect and reactivates ATPase. Thus, the response of ATPase reaction to various substances probably depends on both the intracellular pH and ion composition and on those of the environmental medium. The fact that ATPase in Cucurbita roots may be stimulated by a joint action of K + and N+ and inhibited by strophanthin suggests that the ATPase of plant tissues resembles to the animal transport ATPases described by SKOU (7). These evidences are of great interest since they help to understand the mechanism of uptake and transport of monovalent cations in a plant cell.

208 Table 3 THE ATPase ACTIVITY OF STEM SEGMENTS TREATED WITH KC1 OR NaCl Treatment

ATPase activity after preincubation in KCl

NaCl

1.62

2.42

Mg + + + Na+ 50 mM + K + 10 mM

1.60 2.78

2.40

Mg + + + Na + + K + + strophan. 0. 05 mM

1.26

2.28

-

Mg + + 3 mM

1. 80

500 mg of 5 mm stem segments were preincubated in a 10 mM solution of KC1 or NaCl at 0° C during 18 hours. A surface ATPase activity was then determinated by placing segments in an incubation mixture containing 1. 2 mM ATP, 20 mM tris pH 6. 0 and different cations.

ATPases participating in a transmembrane transport of cations are as a rule characteristic of the cell membrane. We isolated the fractions of cell walls, plastids, mitochondria and microsomes by differential centrifugation (Table 4).

Table 4 THE ATPase ACTIVITY IN DIFFERENT SUBCELLULAR FRACTIONS Fractions

¿imoles Pi/mg protein • h w ++ 3 mM Mg, Na 50 mM K + 10 mM

Mg + + 3 mM

1000g (nucleiand cell walls)

4.3

5. 2

4000 g (plastids)

1.8

2. 1

20000 g (mitochondria)

2.2

2. 5

105 000 g (microsomes)

1.3

2. 7

Incubation with 1. 2 mM ATP, 20 mM tris-HCl pH 7. 2.

209 The protein of a fraction precipitating at 1000 g is found to possess the highest specific ATPase activity. In the main, this activity probably belongs to fragments of the cellular membranes that permeate the cell walls. This enzyme activity is stimulated by sodium and potassium ions. ATPase considerably stimulated by monovalent cations is found also in a microsomal fraction. An addition of Na + and K + to this fractions results in a two- or threefold increase in enzyme activity. Sincethe(Na + -K + ) -ATPase is bound up with the membrane elements, in particular with the external cytoplasmic membranes, it has been found expedient to carry out experiments on an intact root system. These experiments have been carried out to study the participation of the ATPase in cation transport. This problem is at the very point of discussion by plant physiologists, inasmuch as some investigators failed to find any strophanthin influence upon the fluxes of K + into plant cells (4, 6). We also failed to disclose any strophanthin influence upon the influx of K + into the roots of intact plants grown on the Knop solution containing 0. 5 mM K + and 0. 5 mM Na + (Fig. 1). However, if the roots are grown under conditions of a sharply decreased potassium concentration and an increased sodium content in the medium, the influx of potassium into the cells is strophanthin-dependent (Table 6).

Table 6 THE ESTIMATED AND PREDICTED K + -CONCENTRATION IN THE ROOTS OF CUCURBITA PLANTS GROWN WITH LOW POTASSIUM ENVIRONMENTAL CONTENT

experimental condition

E[mV]

K+-content

r

¿Leqiv

n

Lml tissue water J

K + pred initial

-140

4.6

K + estim 32.2

after 2 hrs in 2 mM K + in 2 mM K + stroph.

50.7 39. 0

5-day seed germination in dark was followed by seedlings grown for 5 days on nutrient solution containing 0. 02 mM K + and 1. 0 mM Na + . Other conditions were the same as in Table 5.

210 A similar phenomenon is observed for Na + when it is transported from the cells containing a low sodium concentration (Table 5). Therefore an assumption was made that the strophanthin influence is develop in transport of the cations under conditions of their low concentration only, when the transport probably occurs against the gradient of electrochemical potential. To estimate the gradient of electrochemical potential in the root cells the membrane potential was measured and intracellular concentration of potassium and sodium ions was calculated by the Nernst equation. These concentrations should be attained if these cations are passively distributed between the cell and the medium. It was found that potassium distribution- is close to electrochemical equilibrium. At the same time a high Na gradient was found to be directed from the medium into the cell; therefore a "pump" must have to be in the cell so as to transfer Na uphill. It is in this case that the effect of strophanthin is exhibited. A contrary phenomenon takes place for potassium - depleted plants. In this case a gradient of electrochemical potential for K+ is directed from the cell into the medium; therefore, a K + - influx mechanism is required to maintain an intracellular potassium level. And this is inhibited by strophanthin. Thus, the strophanthin inhibition effect develops only when the ionic fluxes are directed uphill. This fact is in strict accordance with the USSING criterion of active transport (9). Proceeding from this the (Na-K) -activated ATPase in the root tissues may be considered as a mechanism of cation active transport.

REFERENCES (1)

ATKINSON, M.R., G. M. POLYA, Austr. J. Biol. Sci., 20, (1967), 1069

(2)

BROWN, H. D., A. ALTSCHUL, Biochem. Biophys. Res. Comm., 15, (1964), 479

(3)

BONTING, S. L . , In E. E. BITTAR, ed., Membranes and Ion Transport, London, (1970), 286 CRAM, W . J . , J. Exp.Bot., 19, (1968), 611 FISHER, J . , T.K. HODGES, PL Physiol., 44, (1969), 385 HODGES, T . K . , Nature, 209, (1966), 425 SKOU, J. C., Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 23, (1957), 394 SKOU, J . C . , Prog. Biophys. Mol. Biol., 14, (1964), 134 USSING, H.H., Physiol. Rev., 49, (1949), 127

(4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9)

211

experimental condition

cation content Meq/g tissies K+

Na+

68. 0

4. 0

in 2m M K +

77.5

2.7

in 2m M K + + strophanthin

77.0

6. 8

initial

out

membrane

in

E=-130 mV

1 / /

[K + ] =0. 5mM K +

after 2 hrs [Na+] =0. 5mM Na+ o H

— [ O e = 7 2 mM — [K] p =78mM ÎNÎl L J £|=4. 2m M + > )[Na ] p =78mM

strophanthin

Fig. 1. Effect of strophanthin on the cation content in plant root. Seeds germinated vor 5 days at 25 °C in dark on the filter paper moisted with tap water. The following 5 days the young seedlings were grown on Knop nutrient solution containing 0. 5 mM K + and 0. 5 mM Na + . Cation contents - [ C ] e " were determined by flame photometry in cold-water extract of roots immediately or after K + -uptake from the nutrient solution containing 2 mM K+ and 0. 5 mM Na + with or without strophanthin. The electropotential measurements were made with glass microelectrodes by usual technique. The predicted cation concentration - [ C ] p - was calculated by the Nernst equation.

Physiologisch-chemisches Institut der Karl-Marx-Universität Leipzig

D. DETTMER, F. MULLER, H. -J. GLANDER THE INTERACTION OF MONOSACCHARIDES WITH INTESTINAL (Na"1"-!^)-ATPase

In 1958 RIKLIS and QUASTEL (1) detected effects of monovalent cations on glucose absorption. They concluded that sodium is essential for glucose transport. Since that time this effect was intensively investigated. With the accumulation technique CRANE (2) could demonstrate the to-day well known effect of Na + on the affinity of the transport system for its substrate (sugar). For 6-deoxy-glucose a s substrate the apparent K ^ increased about 200-fold by reducing the Na + concentration from 145 Equ/l to zero, while V was always constant. CRANE IllaX

postulated a ternary complex consisting of Na , glucose and the carrier molecule which passes through the membrane. The affinity of the carrier to the monosaccharide is regulated by the Na + -concentration and vice versa. The Na + -sugarcarrier-complex is built up on the mucosal surface of the brush border, passes through the membrane and dissociates at the intracellular face. The obligatory asymmetry of the Na + -distribution is maintained by the active extrusion of Na + by the Na + -pump. The inhibition of active sugar transport by cardiac glycosides like ouabain was interpreted a s an effect on this Na + -pump. Later SCHULTZ and ZALUSKY (3) localized this pumping on the serosal membrane of the epithelial cell. This model suggested a twofold involvement of Na + in the active sugar transport: 1. Direct coupling between sodium and sugar influx, 2. active Na + -extrusion for maintenance the low intracellular Na + -concentration. Thus the enzymatic basis of active Na + -transport - the (Na + -K + ) -ATPase - is involved only in an indirect manner. In an earlier publication we have described experimental results which can hardly be explained by this model DETTMER et al. (4). The activity of the (Na^K*) -ATPase was decreased under conditions of an increased sugar transport. In accordance with other authors we also found an inhibition of the (Na ATPase by glucose. Besides there exists no simple correlation between sugar

214 transport and (Na + -K + )-ATPase activity. On the basis of these results we discussed the possible role of the phosphorylated intermediate of the (Na + -K + )-ATPase for active sugar transport. Also some results in the literature can be interpreted in the same manner - factors which dephosphorylize the intermediate, show inhibitory effects on the sugar transport. BOSACKOVA and CRANE (5) found an inhibition of sugar transport by L i + , Rb + , Cs + , NH*, i. e. ions which all dephosphorylate the intermediate. On the other hand, extracellular Na+ is essential for active sugar transport but inhibits the ATPase SCHATZMANN (6). KIMMICH (7) investigated the sugar accumulation in isolated intestinal cells. He concluded, that the Na+-gradient is not a condition for uphill monosaccharide transport. On the basis of inhibition experiments with ouabain, oligomycin and dinitrophenol he discussed a direct involvement of the (Na + -K + ) -ATPase in active sugar transport. The key to this problem is to investigate interactions of glucose with the (Na + -K + ) ATPase. The first step was the isolation and purification of a (Na + -K + ) -ATPase from intestinal mucosa of rats. We have got a preparation of good stability (one month and more at -20°), good activity (about 2 I. U. per mg protein, measured at 37°) and a ratio of Mg + + to Mg + + -Na + -K + activity of 1:1. The basic enzymatic properties of our preparation were similar to those published by other authors. Our (Na4 K 4 ) -ATPase was inhibited by ouabain, phloridzin and SH-reagents. Of special interest was the glucose effect. Glucose inhibits intestinal (Na + -K + )-ATPase (Fig. 1). The inhibitory effect is dependent on the sodium and potassium concentration and the sodium-potassium concentration ratio. The greatest inhibitory effect is detectable at low Na + - and K + -concentrations. Further we observed an other glucose effect: the Na + -activation curve was altered by increasing K + -concentrations to a sigmoid shape. If glucose is present simultaneously the Na + -activation curve becomes sigmoidal at lower K + -concentrations. Galactose, mannose, and 3 - 0 methyl-glucose act principally in the same manner, whereas arabinose is without any influence. The kinetic effect is most clear demonstrable in the Eadie plots (Fig. 2). Without glucose, the HILL-coefficients for the Na + activation curve increase linearly between 10 - 100 mM K + , but with 10 mM glucose the increase is steeper with nearly maximal values between 40 - 60 mM K + . PRIESTLAND and WHITTAM (8) studied the alteration of the Reactivation curve with red cell ghosts. With this preparation a strict separation of the K*-

215

and Na + -activating sites was possible. The sigmoidicity occurs only, when Na + acts on the extracellular K + -activating site. In this sense our results can be interpreted as effects of extracellular sodium and glucose on the ATPase. Extracellular Na+ and glucose can be regarded as negative allosteric effectors which increase the cooperativity. In order to study the molecular basis of the glucose effect it is necessary to analize the action of glucose on the several steps of the (Na + -K + ) -ATPase. Fig. 3 shows a model of reaction sequences for the phosphorylation of (Na + -K + )-ATPase Post et al. (9). There are various steps: ATP:ADP exchange - Mg + + , Na+-dependent building of a phosphorylated intermediate - its conversion to a second phosphorylated intermediate- and a K+-dependent dephosphorylation. The Na+-dependent phosphorylation is reversible but the interconversion of the two intermediates is irreversible. As possible phosphorylated products KAHLENBERG et al. (10) isolated j -glutaminyl phosphate and AHMED AND JUDAH (11) serine phosphate. The first step, the Na+-dependent phosphorylation can be studied with labelled ATP. There are two kinds ob labelling - an unstable and a stable one SKOU (11a). It is most likely that the unstable labelling represents an acyl phosphate like y -glutaminyl phosphate. Possibly serine phosphate causes the stable labelling. The inhibition of the (Na + -K + ) -ATPase by diisopropylfluorophosphate SACHS (12) is in accordance with this assumption. The K+-dependent dephosphorylation step can be investigated separately as K + stimulated p-nitrophenyl-phosphatase. This is a further evidence for the presence of an hydroxyl group in the active center. Inhibition experiments with SH-reagents allow to postulate a SH-group being involved in the catalytic process. In our experiments the K + -stimulated phosphatases were inhibited by mersalylic acid, while is has only little effect on the Na+-dependent phosphorylation. SIEGEL and ALBERS (13) described similar effects by NEM and localized the SH-group between the two phosphorylated intermediates. Cardiac glycosids, such as ouabain, inhibit the dephosphorylation at low concentrations SKOU (lib), HOKIN (14) investigated the inhibition of (Na + -K + )ATPase by glycosides and haloderivatives of glycosides. Strophanthidin-3haloacetates caused inhibition being irreversible to about 70 %. HOKIN discussed alkylation of the enzyme at a SH-group near the site, where the cardiac glycosides act.

216

WEISS (15) gives a plausible explanation for the reaction between the functional groups in analogy of the molecular mechanism of 3-glycerol aldehyde phosphate dehydrogenase. He discussed a thioacyl bond between the f-carboxyl group of glutaminic acid and a SH-group leading to conformational changes of the whole enzyme. In our studies glucose had little influence on the total amount of phosphate incorporated in the first reaction step, the forming of a phosphorylated intermediate, but the break down was clearly retarded. (Fig. 4). Thus we could demonstrate that glucose has a stabilizing effect on the intermediate. On the other hand glucose inhibits the phosphatase activity, and the K-activation curve of the phosphatase is influenced by glucose in the same manner as the Na + activation curve of the (Na-K T )-ATPase. (Fig. 5). Both glucose effects - the inhibition of the overall activity and the altering of the kinetic behaviour can be localized at the phosphatase site which represents the dephosphorylation step and the extracellular site of the (Na+-K+) -ATPase. Most likely (Na + -K + )-ATPase is present in most membranes. ROSENBERG et al. (16) could demonstrate it also in the intestinal brush border membrane. Na + and glucose could act a s negative allosteric effectors on the mucosal face of the brush border membrane. All this facts and comments we have summarized in the following hypothetical model of (Na^K*)-ATPase (Fig. 6). ATP will be split if Mg ++ and Na + are present. The terminal phosphate is t r a n s ferred to ay-carboxyl group glutaminic acid. Thereby this group becomes able to react with a thiol group. The phosphate from acyl phosphate is transferred simultaneously to the OH-group of serine. This ester phosphate is then hydrolized in a K + -dependent step. ASKARI et al. (17) investigated the effect of oligomycin on the ATPase. Oligomycin inhibits the (Na + -K 4 ) -ATPase, though it is without any influence on the K + stimulated phosphatases. But it inhibits the activation of the phosphatases by Na + and ATP. ASKARI et al. discuss an effect of oligomycin on the interconversion of the two phosphorylated intermediates. According to the model described above oligomycin acts on the conformational state caused by the thioacylation bond. We also found inhibitory and cooperative effects of Na + and glucose on the phosphatase, which may be regarded a s allosteric effects at the same site. The conformation state induced by the thioacylation bond and influenced by Na + , glucose, and oligomycin could be discussed as a special energized state of membrane essential for ion and sugar transport.

217

REFERENCES (1)

RIKLIS, E . , J . H . QUASTEL, Canad. J . Biochem. Physiol., 36. (1958), 347

(2)

CRANE, R. K . , Fed. P r o c . , 2 ( 1 9 6 5 ) ,

(3)

SCHULTZ, S . G . , R. ZALUSKY, J . Gen. Physiol., £7, (1964), 1043

1000

(4)

DETTMER, D . , F . MÜLLER, E. KÜHFAHL, Acta Biol. Med. German., 18, (1967), 555

(5)

BOSACKOVA, I . , R. K. CRANE, Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 102, (1965), 423

(6)

SCHATZMANN, H . J . , Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 94, (1965), 89

(7)

KIMMICH, G . A . , Biochemistry, 9, (1970), 3669

(8)

PRIESTLAND, R. N . , R. WHITTAM, Biochem. J . , 109, (1968), 309

(9) (10)

POST, R. L . , 54, S. KUME, Physiol, (1969), T. 306TOBIN, B. ORCUTT, A. K. SEN, J . Gen. KAHLETOERG, A . , P. R. GALSWORTHY, L. E. HOKIN, Science, 157, (1967), 434

(11)

AHMED, K . , J . D . JUDAH, Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 104, (1965), 112

(IIa) SKOU, J . C . , Physiol. R e v . , 45, (1965), 596 (lib) SKOU, J . C . , C. HILBERG, Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 185, (1969), 198 (12)

SACHS, G . , E. Z. FINLEY, T. TSUIJ, I . B . Biochem. Biophys., 134, (1969), 497

(13)

SIEGEL, G . J . , R . W . ALBERS, J . Biol. Chem., 242, (1967), 4972

(14)

HOKIN, L. E . , M. MOKOTOFF, S. M. KU PC HAN, Proc. nat. Acad.

(15)

WEISS, D. E . , Austral. J . Biol. S e i . , 22, (1969), 1373

(16)

ROSENBERG, I. H . , L. E. ROSENBERG, Comp. Biochem. Physiol., 24, (1968), 975

(17)

ASKARI, A . , D. HOYAL, Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun., 32, (1968), 227

fflRSCHOWITZ,

Arch.

Sei. U . S . A . , 55, (1966), 797

218

Fig. • O— 3

1. • O »

Inhibition of the (Na + -K + )-ATPase by glucose under several conditions. with 20 mM K+ and 100 mM Na + with 2 mM K+ and 50 mM Na + with 2 mM K+ and 6, 25 mM Na +

relob're activity

Fig. 2. Eadie-plots of the Na + -activation curve of the (Na + -K + )-ATPase at different K + -concentrations and with and without glucose. • • with 10 mM K+ ® 9 with 10 mM K and 10 mM glucose • • with 40 mM K + O O with 40 mM K and 10 mM glucose

219

ATP*

Na', Mg" ~

-P

4/tOP

Hg" K'

E.-P

+HtO

' Ouabain ß

+OuE

E-Ou—P *HiO

Mg*

Fig. 3. Reaction scheme of the phosphorylation steps of the (Na + -K + )-ATPase (POST et al.)

Fig. 4. Influence of glucose on building and break down of the phosphorylated intermediate. O O with 3 mM Mg , 100 mM Na and 100 mM glucose • • with 3 mM Mg + + , 100 mM Na +

h 1 too mM fOO

to m M glue.

o,s rtloli 've activity

v

to

Fig. 5. Eadie-plots of the K + -activation curve of the K + -stimulated p-nitrophenylphosphatase at several conditions. 9 9 with 100 mM Na + and 10 mM glucose O o with 100 mM Na + 0 0 without Na + and glucose.

220

Fig. 6. Hypothetical model of the mechanism of the (Na + -K + )-ATPase and the interaction with glucose.

Physiologisch-chemisches Institut der Karl-Marx-Universität Leipzig

F. MÜLLER, D. DETTMER, H. REMKE MONOSACCHARIDE DEPENDENT Na + -FLUXES ACROSS INTESTINAL EPITHELIUM AND THEIR POSSIBLE RELATIONS TO (Na+-K+) -ATPase

The problem we deal with is the mechanism of the coupled Na + - and monosaccharide transport across the microvilli membrane of the mucosal cell of small intestine. Fig. 1 demonstrates the CRANE hypothesis about the coupling mechanism. This model (1, 2) envisions a mobile membrane carrier, which has binding sites for both, the sodium ion and the sugar molecule. Na + increases the affinity of the carrier to the sugar and vice versa. Therefore in the high sodium enviroment a sodium-sugar-carrier-complex is readily formed, while at the relative sodium poor enviroment (intracellular) the complex dissociates. The energy necessary for the accumulation of an actively transported monosaccharide against its concentration gradient is dependent on an inwardly directed sodium gradient. The model includes an obligatory link and high degree of correlation between the unidirectional fluxes of sodium and monosaccharide. In order to test this model, we have investigated the unidirectional sodium influx into the cells of rat jejunum in the presence of various monosaccharides. Two kinds of methods a r e available for measurements of unidirectional Na + -fluxes across the cell membrane. 1. The tracer is added to the mucosal compartment and transported into the epithelial cells, and the tracer appearence - it equals the net flux across the intestinal wall - can be measured continuously in the serosal compartment (Fig. 2). The fluxes across the microvilli membrane may be calculated from the tracer appearance rate and the intracellular sodium concentration (3). 2. The second method is a short-time incubation method (4, 5) for direct determination of the sodium influx. Fig. 3 shows that the uptake of labelled Na + is directly dependent on the time of incubation up to 50 sec, and gives a straight line, which indicates that only influx occurs, which may be calculated from the increment of the intracellular tracer content.

222

Result s Na + - net fluxes: Fig. 4 demonstrates, that the sodium net fluxes in the presence of nonmetabolizable sugars, for instance actively transported galactose and passively transported arabinose, are nearly identical and do not differ from the control values without sugar. On the other hand in the presence of a metabolizable sugar (glucose) the Na + -net flux is increased by about 50 % (possibly a secondary effect caused by lactate production). These results are not in agreement with the CRANE hypothesis, because there is no distinction between actively and passively transported sugars. Na + - influx: Fig. 5 shows the unidirectional Na + -influx, measured with the shorttime incubation method, across the microvilli membrane under the influence of various monosaccharides. Again, the value in the presence of 10 mM of arabinose does not differ from the control. The surprising result is the decreased influx of sodium under the influence of glucose. In the presence of galactose there is only a small increase. Intracellular Na + concentrations: Fig. 6 demonstrates experiments on isolated mucosal sheets, incubated in 10 mM galactose and 145 mM Na + . During the accumulation of sugar (initially up to 6 fold in relation to the medium) the intracellular Na + -concentration increases. After reversion of the Na + -gradient (intracellular Na + -concentration > 145 mM), there is still an accumulation of galactose in the cells. That means, the sodium gradient could not be the only energy source for uphill sugar transport. A reasonable explanation would be that a direct energy input into the sugar transport system exists, for instance an ATP-driven carrier. It was suggested by K3MMICH (6), that monosaccharide transport system is directly linked to the energy supply system by (Na + -K + )dependent ATPase. Fig. 7 represents his conception for the reactions and equilibria between ATP, the phosphorylated intermediates and the monosaccharide transport. It provides an explanation especially for the accumulation of monosaccharides against the sodium gradient by direct energy supply by ATP. But it is known that the ATPase reaction is principally reversible, i. e. even the sodium influx caused by an inwardly directed Na + -gradient is able to produce ATP from ADP (7, 8, 9,10). Therefore we have modified this reaction scheme by introducing ion fluxes in the following manner (Fig. 8). We propose that the Na + , K + -gradients, resp. the corresponding fluxes, influence the ATPase-equilibria

223

by a mechanism, where Na+ or K + -intra- and extracellular-act like substrates on the ATPase. The free energy of ATP-hydrolysis could be utilized for the vectorial reaction, which lead to monosaccharide- and K + -influx and to Na + -efflux against their gradients, but also the free energy of the inwardly directed sodium gradient could be converted for the same purpose. This would explain an increase in the intracellular Na + - and a decrease in the K + -concentration during galactose transport, because the equilibria are shifted to the left. On the other hand raising of the intracellular ATP level (by metabolism of glucose) would shift the reactions to the right and lead to a decreased Na+-influx.

REFERENCES (1)

CRANE, R. K., Fed. Proc. 24, (1965), 1000

(2)

LYON, I . , R. K. CRANE, Biochem. biophys. Acta, 112, (1966), 278

(3)

CURRAN, P. F . , F. C. HERRERA, C. F. FLANIGAN, J . Gen. Physiol. 46, (1963), 1011

(4)

SCHULTZ, S . G . , P . F . CURRAN, R. A. CHEZ, R. E. FUISZ, J . Gen. Physiol. 50, (1967), 1241

(5)

GOLDNER, A. W., S.G. SCHULTZ, P . F . CURRAN, J . Gen. Physiol., 53,

(6)

KEMMICH, G. A., Biochemistry, 9, (1970), 3669

(1969), 362 (7)

PRIESTLAND, R. N., R. WHITTAM, J . Physiol., 204, (1969), 49

(8)

LANT, A. F . , R. WHITTAM, J . Physiol., 207, (1969), 291

(9)

GLYNN, I . M . , V.L. LEW, U. LÜTHI, J . Physiol., 207, (1969), 371

(10)

WHITTAM, R . , K.P. WHEELER, Ann. Rev. Physiol., 32, (1970), 21

224

Fig. 1. The Crane model for a mobile membrane carrier with binding sites for sodium and sugar. (Kf = sugar concentration for half maximal transport velocity).

-compartment

2

intestinal lumen $T2

epithelial

cell

serosal incubation medium

$23

is washed out

$

continuously

microvillimembrane

basal membrane

931

serosa

therefore $32~-0

what is to be measured: f$co~ radioactivity in compt. 2 (steady state) dPj/dt - tracer appeararance in compt.3

Fig. 2. Compartment system of isolated intestinal wall. Labelled Na + is transported from the mucosal compartment (1) across the mucosal cells (2) to serosal compartment (3).

225 7-W3 cpm 6 5 4 3

Fig. 3. Linear uptake of labelled sodium from the mucosal compartment into the cells during short time incubation.

2

0

70

20

30

40

50

60

Fig. 4. Steady state Na + -net fluxes in the presence of galactose, arabinose and glucose. Incubation medium: KrebsHenseleit-buffer, monosaccharide: 10 mM, Na+: 145 mM, tracer: 2 2Na + . GLUC. 10 mM

Fig. 5. Steady state sodium influxes (mucosal compartment —»- epithelial cell) of glucose, galactose and arabinose. Incubation medium: Krebs-Henseleit-buffer, monosaccharide: 10 mM, Na + : 145 mM, tracer: 22 N a+. GLUC. WmM

226 180 mM m HO

120

V z

80

60 40

» 15

30

45

60

Fig. 6. Incubation of isolated mucosal sheets: Time-dependence of the intracellular galactose-, Na + - and K + -concentrations. Incubation medium: Krebs-Henseleit-buffer, monosaccharide: 10 mM, Na + : 145 mM, t r a c e r : 22 Na+

E2~POuab.

E Ouab.-

+0uab.

+0uab. Oligom. Na+,Mg++

ATP+i ••

K+ .

Ei ~ P ; ADP

M9

m'TPANSPORT

'PMor. AM/mCIOMONOSACCHARIDETRAHSPOPT

Fig. 7. Equilibrium reactions of the (Na, K)-dependent ATPase between ATP, the phosphorylated intermediats and their relations to monosaccharide transport (according to K3MMICH (6)).

glycolysis-~-ATP+E unidirect monosacch mosacch fluxes

•-E+P,

V-OUt

Na+influx

t-effhix

-E-PV

Fig. 8. Modified scheme of the involvement of the (Na + , K + ) -dependent ATPase in sugar and ion transport.

Biochemisches Institut der Universität Freiburg im Breisgau and Gesellschaft für Strahlen- und Umweltforschung München

H. HOLZER

REGULATION OF ENZYMES BY PHOSPHORYLATION AND ADENYLYLATION

Introduction Glycogen phosphorylase from muscle is the classical case of an enzyme which is regulated by phosphorylation/dephosphorylation. Since the discovery of this regulatory system by CORI et al. (1) and FISCHER and KREBS (2) some other enzymes have been found which are regulated by phosphorylation/dephosphorylation, and furthermore a distinct, but principally similar mechanism, namely adenylylation/deadenylylation has been established. Thus the importance of the regulation of enzymes by ATP-dependent chemical modification, i. e. phosphorylation and adenylylation, is becoming more and more generally recognized (for recent reviews see (3,4) ).

Table 1 ENZYMES REGULATED BY PHOSPHORYLATION/DEPHOSPHGRYLATION AND ADENYLYLATION/DEADENYLYLATION Phosphorylation/Dephosphorylation

Adenylylation/Deadenylylation

Glycogen phosphorylase

Glutamine synthetase

Phosphorylase b kinase

RNA Polymerase (?)

Phosphorylase a phosphatase (?) Glycogen synthetase Synthetase phosphatase (?) Fructose diphosphatase Pyruvate dehydrogenase complex Lipase (?) Palmityl CoA-Synthetase (?)

232 Table 1 lists the enzymes known at present to be regulated by phosphorylation/ dephosphorylation and adenylylation/deadenylylation. In some cases, a s indicated by a question mark, there is only indirect evidence for such a mechanism. The first five enzymes of this list, all involved in the regulation of degradation and synthesis of glycogen, and the last, RNA polymerase, are treated in other parts of this symposium, and therefore will not be discussed here. Fructose diphosphatase: In 1966 MENDICINO et al. (5) demonstrated that purified fructose-1, 6-diphosphata from kidney is inactivated upon incubation with the crude kidney extract in the 2+

presence of ATP and Mg . The inactivating system of the crude extract is tightly bound to mitochondria (6). In recent experiments MENDICINO (7) has 32 shown that during incubation with ff - P-labeled ATP the in inactivation of the 32 enzyme proceeds parallel to the incorporation of P into trichloracetic acidinsoluble material. Results of a typical experiment are shown in Table 2. The results of MENDICINO et al. are summarized in Fig. 1. A stimulating effect of cyclic 3', 5' -AMP on inactivation of the enzyme, a s described by MENDICINO

Table 2 TIME COURSE OF INACTIVATION OF LIVER-D-FRUCTOSE 1, 6-DIPHOSPHATASE AND TRANSFER OF PHOSPHATE FROM ATP 3 2 Time (min)

Radioactivity (cpm) 0

D-Fructose 1,6-diphosphatase Activity (¿imoles/min)

5 10

12. 890

52,8 40.5 31.7

15

18. 830

24.6

0

6.510

J . MENDICINO: personal communication to H. HOLZER, 1970.

233

et al. (5) is included in this figure. It seems that this system is part of the general regulatory system which is controled by cyclic 3 ' , 5' -AMP and includs several enzymes which participate as key enzymes in gluconeogenesis. Pyruvate dehydrogenase complex: Two years ago LINN et al. (8, 9) showed that the pyruvate dehydrogenase complexes (PDC) from beef kidney, beef heart, and pork liver mitochondria are inactivated by an enzyme-catalyzed, ATP-dependent phosphorylation and reactivated by enzyme-catalyzed dephosphorylation. Similar results have been obtained by WIELAND et al. (10,11) working with PDC from pig heart mitochondria. Phosphorylation/dephosphorylation of PDC seems to play an important role in the hormonal regulation of this enzyme. Thus in fed rats about 70 % of the complex is in the active form, whereas in fasted rats less than 5 % is active WIELAND et al. (12) and treatment of alloxan-diabetic rats with insulin increases the ratio of active to inactive PDC. Lipase: As shown by CORBIN et al. (13) lipase from adipose tissue can be activated by a cyclic 3 ' , 5' -AMP-dependent protein kinase from skeletal muscle. This finding makes it probable that this enzyme, like other enzymes participating in gluconeogenesis, is activated by cyclic AMP-dependent phosphorylation. HUTTUNEN et al. (14,15) have now been able to demonstrate that phosphorylation of rat lipase by means of a protein kinase from rabbit muscle parallels its activation. This correlation may be seen clearly in Fig. 2, where both enzyme 32 32 activity and incorporation of P from P-ATP into a trichloroacetic acidinsoluble fraction are plotted against time. Since there is at present only indirect evidence for a kinase in adipose tissue similar to that in muscle a question mark is suffixed to lipase (Table 1). Palmityl CoA synthetase: Microsomal palmityl CoA synthetase from rat liver can be activated by incubation 2+

with equimolar concentrations of ATP and Mg , and inactivated by incubation 2+ with 5 mM Mg in the absence of ATP (16,17,18). By analogy to results found with crude preparations of glycogen phosphorylase, which are explained by enzyme catalyzed phosphorylation/dephosphorylation, FARSTADT (19) suggest that palmityl CoA synthetase is also regulated by a phosphorylation/dephosphorylation mechanism.

234 Glutamine synthetase: In 1966 an enzyme which inactivates purified glutamine synthetase from E. coli in the presence of ATP, Mg^ + , and glutamine was discovered and purified (20). Subsequent work by the group of EARL STADTMAN in Bethesda (21) and by the group in Freiburg (3,4) has shown that specific enzymes catalyze effector dependent adenylylation and deadenylylation of glutamine synthetase and thereby its inactivation and reactivation respectively. The current status of this regulatory system, based on the results of these two laboratories, is summarized in Fig. 3. Very recently ANDERSON and STADTMAN (22) have presented evidence, that the reactivation of glutamine synthetase b by deadenylylation is effected not by hydrolysis, but by phosphorolysis of the esterified AMP, forming ADP. Formation of the energy-rich pyrophosphate bond in ADP from adenylylated glutamine synthetase is reasonable from an energetic point of view, because MANTEL and HOLZER (23) have found that the adenylyl-O-tyrosin bond, linking AMP to the protein of glutamine synthetase, is an energy-rich bond as defined by LIPMAN (24). In a subsequent paper at this symposium Dr. WOHLHUETER will present some recent results on this new energy-rich bond. Summary: A list of the enzymes regulated by enzyme-catalyzed phosphorylation/dephosphorylation or adenylylation/deadenylylation is given. Some recent observations on the enzymes for which such a regulatory mechanism has been demonstrated or postulated are presented and discussed.

REFERENCES (1)

CORI, G., A. A. GREEN, J . Biol. Chem. 151, (1943), 31

(2)

FISCHER, E . H . , E.G. KREBS, J . Biol. Chem. 216, (1955), 121

(3)

HOLZER, H., Advanc. in Enzymology 32, (1969), 297

(4)

HOLZER, H., W. DUNTZE, Ann. Rev. Biochemistry 40, (1971), in press

(5)

MENDICINO, J . , C. BEAUDREAU, R.N. BHATTACHARYYA, Arch. Biochim. Biophys. 116, (1966), 436

(6)

MENDICINO, J . , H.S. PRIHAR, F . M . SALMA, J . Biol. Chem. 243, (1968), 2710

(7)

MENDICINO, J . , personal communication to H. HOLZER 1970

235

LINN, T . C . , F . H . PETTIT, L . J . REED, Proc.Natl. Acad. Sei. U.S.A. 62, (1969), 234 LINN, T. C . , F . H . PETTIT, F. HUCHO, L . J . REED, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sei. U.S.A. 64, (1969), 227 WIELAND, O . , E. SIESS, Hoppe-Seyler' s Z. Physiol. Chem. 350, (1970), 1160 WIELAND, O . , B . v . JAGOW-WESTERMANN F E B S - L e t t e r s 3, (1969), 271 WIELAND, O . , E. SIESS, F . H . SCHULZE-WETHMAR, 1st Int. Symp. on Metabolie Interconversion of Enzymes, St. Margherita (1970), 52 CORBIN, J . D., E.M. REIMANN, D.A. WALSH, E.G. KREBS, J . Biol. Chem. 245, (1970), 4849 HUTTUNEN, J . K., D. STEINBERG, St. E. MAYER, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sei. U.S.A. 67, (1970), 290 HUTTUNEN, J . K , D. STEINBERG, St. E. MAYER, Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 41, (1970), 1350 FARSTADT, M . , Biochim. Biophys. Acta 146, (1967), 272 AAS, M., Biochim. Biophys. Acta 202, (1970), 250 FARSTADT, M., Acta Physiol. Scand. 74, (1968), 568 FARSTADT, M . , 1st Int. Symp. on Metabolie Interconversion of Enzymes, St. Margherita (1970), 70 MECKE, D . , K. WULFF, K. LIESS, H. HOLZER, Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 2 ( 1 9 6 6 ) , 452 STADTMAN, E . R . , B. M. SHAPIRO, A. GINSBURG, H. S. KINGDON, M.D. DENTON, Brookhaven Symp. Biol. 21, (1968), 378 ANDERSON, W. B . , E. R. STADTMAN, Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 41, (1970), 704 MANTEL, M . , H. HOLZER, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sei. U . S . A . 65,(1970), 660 LIPMANN, F . , Advances in Enzymol. 1, (1941), 99

236

Kinase

(dephosphorylated enzyme)

(phosphorylated enzyme)

Phosphatase ? Fig. 1. Regulation of kidney fructose-1,6diphosphatase according to MENDICINO et al. (5,6,7).

Fig. 2. Rat adipose tissue lipase and rabbit muscle protein kinase with K - P-ATP (15). '

237 Glutaalne

Glutaiine synthetase (GSa, active)

cx-fotoglutarate

Glutanine synthetase-UMP)^ (GSb, inactive)

Fig. 3. Regulation of glutamine synthetase from E. coli by enzyme-catalyzed chemical modification. © = positive effector (stimulation), © = negative effector (inhibition).

Instituto de Enzimologia, Centro de Investigaciones Biológicas, Consejo Superior de Investigaciones Científicas, Madrid, Spain

ALBERTO SOLS ALLOSTERIC EFFECTS BY PRODUCTS AND SUBSTRATES INVOLVING SPECIFICALLY REGULATORY SITES

In the three-dimensional world of regulation of enzyme activity, openend by UMBARGER and PARDEE fifteen years ago (1, 2) and generalized by MONOD, CHANGEUX and JACOB (3) in the early sixties, almost anything convenient is possible. Virtually any compound can be a specific effector of an enzyme, if such an effect is useful for the overall economy of a cell, no matter how chemically unrelated the compound is to the substrate(s) and product(s). Or viceversa: even for substrates and products there can be specific regulatory sites. Any "strange" effect by a substrate or product should be considered from the point of view of this possibility. The term allosteric, introduced in metabolic regulation by the Pasteur group has been a success, but, although initially it filled an important role in the developing field of specific regulatory mechanisms, it has been mixed blessing. The initial physiological emphasis tended to be shifted to a certain mechanistic model (4). Unfortunately the two largely independent concepts have been widely used in parallel, and frequently in a rather loose way. The term allosteric in current enzymology and metabolic regulation has just become a fashionable term that tends uncosciously to be used in connection with almost of inhibitory or activation effects. The famous nonbiochemist scientist popularly known as Lewis Carrol, in his logic-filled tale "Through the looking glass" quoted Humpty Dumpty a s saying: "When I use a word, it means just what I choose it to mean -neither more nor less. " Now, using the freedom allowed by the lack of formal agreement and the notorious ambiguity in current use, I will adopt for the term allosteric in this particular discussion the meaning of chemical transducer involving more than one kind of specific binding site in an enzyme, i. e . , having "another specificity" in addition to that for substrate(s) and product(s). The aim of this discussion is precisely to present a few well defined cases of allosteric effects by products

240 and substrates in the field of phosphotransferases and to discuss general criteria to distinguish effects by substrates and products involving different, specifically regulatory sites, from homotropic cooperative effects, positive or negative, in multimeric proteins as well as from competitive isosteric inhibition by products acting at the active site. Four kinases are involved in the classical glycolytic pathway. In most organisms they are, in the order of their involvement in the pathway, hexokinase, phosphofructokinase, phosphoglycerate kinase and pyruvate kinase. Phosphofructokinase has long been recognized as a major pacemaker. Hexokinase was also a good candidate for metabolic regulation and this has been shown to be the case in most animal tissues. Less predictable, was the recent identification of regulatory in certain pyruvate kinases, in relation with potential gluconeogenesis in most eucaryotic non-photosynthetic organisms. For good reasons, although casually it look, like a mere chance, a common feature of these three kinases is that each of them is affected by a product or substrate in a "strange" way that can be shown to be genuinely allosteric, as defined above for the present discussion. Within the glycolytic pathway only phosphoglycerate kinase has never appeared as a likely candidate for metabolic regulation, . . . at least until the identification of a polyphosphate dependent enzyme in certain primitive microorganisms described by KULAEV (5). Inhibition of animal hexokinases by glucose 6-P The hexokinases from animal tissues (but not yeast hexokinase nor liver glucokinase) are strongly inhibited by glucose 6-P at concentrations within the physiological range. Specificity studies indicate that there is an inhibitory site in the enzyme markedly different from that of the sugar subsite of the active site, as illustrated in Fig. 1 and Table 1. On this basis Crane and Sols postulated as early as 1954 the occurrence of a binding site specific for inhibition by glucose 6-P and presumably of a regulatory character (6). This strong inhibition by glucose 6-P cannot be reversed by an increase in the concentration of the sugar substrate (6), and acts on the enzyme by decreasing the affinity for the phosphoryl donor (8). In the reverse reaction, glucose 6-P (but not 2-deoxyglucose 6-P) gives a dramatically biphasic curve which reaches very strong inhibition at moderately high concentrations of glucose 6-P, as illustrated in Fig. 2 (9). A summary of independent criteria, which taken together constitute overwhelming evidence of the allosteric character of the marked sensitivity of animal hexokinases

241

Table 1 DIFFERENTIAL SPECIFICITY OF THE SUGAR SUBSTRATE SITE AND THE GLUCOSE 6-P INHIBITORY SITE (6, 7) Inhibitory site

Substrate site Glucose

+++

Glucose 6-P

+++

-

L-Sorbose 1-P

+++

-

ce -Glucose 1, 6-diP

+++

Mannose

+++

Mannose 6-P

-

2-Doxyglucose

+++

2-Deoxyglucose 6-P

-

L-Sorbose ce -Glucose 1-P

Km 1, 5-anhydroglucitol »

Ki 1, 5-anhydroglucitol 6-P

to inhibition by glucose 6-P, is outlined in Table 2. The contrast between this inhibition by glucose 6-P involving a particular modifier site and the isosteric inhibition of hexokinases by ADP at its corresponding product site has been recently emphasized by KOSOW and ROSE (10). It appears that at a certain level in evolution, hexokinase acquiredallosteric sensitivity to feedback inhibition by glucose 6-P, which usually is a primary product and is always a major metabolic crossroads. This allosteric feedback inhibition can efficiently control the glucose phosphorylation pathway in animal tissues, whenever the first step of this pathway, the reversible transport across the cell membrane, is not limiting (11). And since hexokinase is at the same time the irreversible step and the last step of a well defined metabolic pathway, it seems that evolution has favored the selection of an inhibitory site for the endproduct of the path way regardless of the fact that this endproduct is a primary product of the hexokinase reaction. Inhibition of the liver isoenzyme of pyruvate kinase by ATP An adaptive isoenzyme of pyruvate kinase was identified in liver by TANAKA et al. (12), who designated it as PK^. The regulation of the activity of this isoenzyme has been characterized by LLORENTE et al. (13) as an interplay of at least four physiological factors: sigmoidal kinetics respect to the substrate

242

Table 2 ALLOSTERIC INHmiTION OF ANIMAL HEXOKINASES BY GLUCOSE 6-P 1)

Not reverted by excess glucose

2)

Differential specificity: a)

2-Deoxyglucose-6-P and several other primary products corresponding

b)

L-Sorbose-l-P is a strong inhibitor although L-sorbose is not a

to high affinity substrates are not inhibitory substrate nor competitive inhibitor 3)

Absence of significant inhibition in enzymes from other sources: a) yeast hexokinase b)

4)

liver glucokinase

In the reverse reaction glucose-6-P gives inhibition by "excess substrate"

phosphoenolpyruvate, activation by fructosediphosphate and inhibition by alanine and by ATP. Although the latter is a primary product of the pyruvate kinase reaction, and as such an isosteric inhibitor of the isoenzyme typical of the muscle (a tissue unable to carry out gluconeogenesis where phosphoenolpyruvate is not a major metabolic crossroads) a s clearly shown by REYNARD et al. (14), ATP can inhibit PK L by an additional mechanism. The inhibition of PIC^ independent of the concentration of ADP is counteracted by the allosteric activator fructosediphosphate, and the enzyme can be reversibly desensitized by cold treatment (13). We have also found (15) that the high specificity for ATP as inhibor is very different from the wide specificity of the enzyme respect to nucleotide diphosphate as phosphoryl acceptor substrate (Fig. 3). Moreover, specific removal of ATP with an hexokinase - 2-deoxyglucose trap leads to immediate disappearance of the inhibition (13). Table 3 summarizes these and certain other additional criteria (16,17) that converge to substantiate the conclusion that the liver isoenzyme of pyruvate kinase has an allosteric site for inhibition by ATP, independently of the fact that it is a primary product of the reaction catalyzed by the enzyme. This situation parallels that of the inhibition of animal hexokinases by glucose-6-P. Although there are some qualitative and quantitative differences between the criteria summarized in Tables 2 and 3, (the combined weight of the

243

evidence) amply suppost the conclusion that these two peculiar inhibitions by a primary product involve allosteric specifically regulatory sites.

Table 3 ALLOSTERIC INHIBITION OF THE LIVER ISOENZYME OF PYRUVATE KINASE ( P K j j BY ATP 1)

Independent oi the concentration of ADP

2)

Differential specificity: GDP, UDP and IDP a r e good substrates, while GTP, UTP and ITP a r e not good inhibitors

3)

Reversible desensitization by standing in the cold

4)

Counteracted by the allosteric effector FDP

5)

Absence in enzyme from other sources: a)

PKj^. (muscle) and PK A (adipose tissue) isoenzymes

b)

yeasts

Inhibition of yeast phosphofructokinase by ATP Scarcely ten y e a r s ago a race on sensitivity of phosphofructokinases to a variety of factors was started by PASSONNEAU and LOWRY's report (18) of a somewhat bewildering a r r a y of metabolites able to affect the activity of phosphofructokinase in muscle extracts*! One of these effects was inhibition by excess of the substrate ATP. I obtained evidence, working with yeast preparations, that the inhibition of phosphofructokinase by ATP was not linked to the fact of its being a substrate, since other good phosphoryl donor substrates were not inhibitory (19), a s illustrated in Fig. 4 and Table 4. This specific inhibition of yeast phosphofructokinase by ATP can be efficiently counteracted by AMP (20, 21) and by NH^ + 1)

In a visit to St. Louis, Mo., at about this time I gave a seminar on feedback controls in yeast glycolysis. The formal discussion was followed by an informal one between myself and Prof. Carl F. CORI, a distinguished pioneer in pointing to phosphofructokinase a s probably critical for the control of glycolysis. At this time Prof. CORI muttered that phosphofructokinase looked like a "neurotic" enzyme. In tune with this light mood I offered the alternative that phosphofructokinase was perhaps an "allohysteric" enzyme.

244

ions (21), and reinforced by citrate (21, 22). The enzyme can be reversibly desensitized to a relatively stable insensitive form (23), by what seems to involve a complex metabolite induced change relatively stable (24). Irreversible desensitization can be achieved by treatment with trypsin (25, 26). The effects of various ligands, individually and in mixtures on the susceptibility of this desensitization by trypsin, gave additional evidence for the occurrence in native

Table 4 ALLOSTERIC INHIBITION OF YEAST PHOSPHOFRUCTOKINASE BY ATP 1)

Differential specificity: GTP, ITP, CTP and UTP are good substrates, but not inhibitors

2)

Desensitization:

3)

a)

reversible change of form

b)

trypsin treatment

Relationship to other effectors: a) counteracted by AMP b) c)

4)

" by NH 4 + synergistic with inhibition by citrate (?)

Absence in enzyme from other sources Dictyostelium discoideum (28) Arthrobacter crystallopoietes (29) Flavobacterium thermophilum (30)

yeast phosphofructokinase of an ATP regulatory site, and further indicated that the counteraction of the ATP inhibition by AMP had to involve an additional different site, as illustrated in the model represented in Fig. 6 (25, 27). Table 4 summarizes these observations and other indirect evidence that support the conclusion that the inhibition of yeast phosphofructokinase by ATP is indeed allosteric; the convergence of criteria constitutes overwhelming evidence for this conclusion. This conclusion seems to apply also for the phosphofructokinases from higher animals (31) and plants (32). The ATP inhibitable phosphofructokinases are no "hara-kiri" enzymes. Simply,

245

although phosphofructokinase uses ATP as substrate, in most organisms the common glycolytic pathway, of which phosphofructokinase is the first physiologically irreversible enzyme, gives more ATP than that spent on this priming reaction. Hence ATP is a typical endproduct (11,19) and as such can be a very convenient physiological inhibitor of phosphofructokinase, independently of the fact that it happens to be a substrate for the enzyme. The relative affinities for ATP of the corresponding substrate and allosteric site are adjusted so as to tend to make phosphofructokinase activity in situ proportional to the requirements of the cell for ATP, as can be appreciated from Fig. 4. Indeed, in the few cases of organisms with phosphofructokinase not inhibited by ATP, the enzyme seems to serve purposes other than that of energy producing glycolysis (28, 29) or use another energy-rich feedback inhibitor, phosphoenolpyruvate (30). A considerable number of enzymes are somewhat inhibited by excess of a substrate. In the majority of the reported cases these inhibitions are moderate, usually up to about 50 % or so, require concentrations of the inhibitory substaates well above its physiological range, or some otherwise markedly unphysiological condition. No regulatory sites should be postulated on the basis of such flimsy evidence. Typical examples within the area of the phosphotransferases are fructosediphosphatase, the type m of animal hexokinase, and glyceraldehyde 3-phosphate dehydrogenase. Outside this area, the H isoenzyme of animal lactate dehydrogenase is a most conspicous case of premature hopes dissipated by hard facts. Activation of certain phosphofructokinases by one of their products Phosphofructokinase from E. coli can be markedly activated by ADP. Activation by fructosediphosphate has been reported for enzymes from several origins (33). From the results of ATKINSON and coworkers (see 33) and MONOD and collaborators (34), a number of criteria collected in Table 5 converge to amply justify the conclusion that ADP is an allosteric activator for the phosphofructokinase from E. coli, where it obviously constitutes the physiological equivalent to the AMP activation of the enzyme in most other organisms. Thè rationale is of course based on the fact well documented by Atkinson that either AMP or ATP can serve as metabolic signals of low energy charge in the cell (35). What is interesting from an evolutionary point of view and in relation with the possible functional interplays that could be significant for metabolic regulation suggested from some observations in yeasts and animal tissues, is the fact that the

246

Table 5 ACTIVATION OF CERTAIN PHOSPHOFRUCTOK3NASES BY ONE OF THEIR PRODUCTS 1)

E. coli: activation by ADP a)

increases affinity for F6P, shifting the kinetics from sigmoid to hyperbolic

b) c)

counteracts allosteric inhibition by ATP GDP is also a good activator although GTP is only a weak substrate

d)

AMP does not activate

Very likely allosteric 2)

Yeast: a)

activation by FDP

dependent on low concentration of homologous substrate, with sigmoid kinetics

b)

2, 5-anhydroglucitol-6-P, a non-phosphorylable analogue of F6P, behaves similarly

c)

high concentrations of either compound are inhibitory

Conclusion: doubtful significance

fructosediphosphatase of E. coli is inhibited by AMP, just like in the other organisms mentioned. An additional contrast lies in the fact that the catabolic threonine deaminase is activated by AMP, while in Clostridium both enzymes are activated by ADP. In contrast, the available information on the activation of yeast PFK by FDP (21) as summarized in Table 5, makes of doubtful significance the mechanism of this observation. More information on characteristics of the activation by fructosediphosphate reported for the phosphofructokinases of other tissues would be desirable. Summing up An outline of the authenticated cases of specific regulatory sites for products or substrates in glycolytic phosphotransferases, is summarized in Table 6. The present discussion should have substantiated the possibility that certain key enzymes could have allosteric, specifically regulatory sites for a substrate

247

ëo

ti Q. >.

^ 8

x> e o

+

m

+ + +

Xi

+ +

e

+ +

+ + +

o

1 * a

â P . I

1 2 *

l - | CQ O

S >> e

• 2 •w •h a f I

S O 3 e .

I

+

S

+ +

+

+ +

+ +

>>p< XI CD

a

c O

®

o 'S

° t s

2

1

I

I

a 1

+ + +

! • §

m o o tH 3 i» h

«h

o Xi •w to ®

s «

«

CO « .—I •s

H

È? O â

S (0 M

a> M g

ctì

Vi » S3 e .2

5 O o °

1 •h ^ Qa

f "m i O

(D 0) Q

J3 V «

o

1 s

4>

®

m 3

8, S 0 1 45

(H a>

I S 4)

V IO fe

$

os

248 or a p r i m a r y product is quite real and not very infrequent. Nevertheless, it should be emphasized that it meets caution before reaching such conclusion. The criteria described in this discussion that directly or indirectly tend to support or discard such an interpretation a r e a sort of diagnostic t e s t s , which although individually none of them i s unequivocal (although some a r e much less equivocal than others), the coincidence of several of them can greatly help to validate the conclusion that a genuine specifically regulatory site for a substrate or product, but different from the corresponding active site does occur in an enzyme. The examples analyzed in this discussion of allosteric effects by substrates and products include c a s e s of inhibition by product, inhibition by substrate and activation by product. Also possible, but m o r e difficult to analyze and outside my personal experience, i s that some of the activation by substrate now so frequently recognized a s sigmoidal kinetics could not be merely a case of i n t e r actions between identical sites in multimeric proteins but involve a specific regulatory site. If any such were demonstrated to occur it would complete the possibilities of allosteric effects by products and substrates in the r e s t r i c t e d sense adopted for this discussion.

REFERENCES (1)

UMBARGER, H. E . , Science 123, (1956), 848

(2)

YATES, R. A . , A. B. PARDEE, J . Biol. Chem. 221., (1956), 757

(3)

MONOD, J . , J . - P . CHANGEUX, F. JACOB, J . Mol. Biol. 6, (1963), 306

(4)

MONOD, J . , WYMAN, J . - P . CHANGEUX, J . Mol. Biol. 12, (1965), 88

(5)

KULAEV, I. S. this volume

(6)

CRANE, R . K . , A. SOLS, J . Biol. Chem. 210, (1954), 597

(7)

SOLS, A . , R.K. CRANE, J . Biol. Chem. 210, (1954), 581

(8)

FROMM, H . J . , V. ZEWE, J . Biol. Chem. 237, (1962), 1661

(9)

SOLS, A . , G. DELA FUENTE, in preparation

(10)

KOSOW, D. P . , I. A. ROSE, J . Biol. Chem. 245, (1970), 198

(11)

SOLS, A . , In Carbohydrate Metabolism and its Disorders, (F. DICKENS, P . j . RANDLE, W . J . WHELAN, eds.), Academic P r e s s , London, vol. 1, (1968), 53

(12)

TANAKA, T . , Y. HARANO, H. MORIMURA, R. MORI, Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 21, (1965), 55

(13)

LLORENTE, P . , R. MARCO, A. SOLS, Eur. J . Biochem. 13, (1970), 45

249

(14)

REYNARD, A. M. , L. F. HASS, D. D. JACOBSEN and P. D. BOYER, J . Biol. Chem. 236, (1961), 2277

(15)

CARBONELL, J . , R. MARCO, A. SOLS, in preparation

(16)

GANCEDO, J. M. , C. GANCEDO, A. SOLS, Biochem. J . 102, (1967), 23

(17)

MARCO, R . , J . CARBONELL, P. LLORENTE, Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 43, (1971), 126

(18)

PASSONNEAU, J . V . , O. H. LOWRY, Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 7, (1962), 10

(19)

VINUELA, E . , M. L. SALAS, A. SOLS, Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 12, (1963), 140

(20)

RAMAIAH, A . , J . A . HATHAWAY, D . E . ATKINSON, J . Biol. Chem. 239, (1964), 3619

(21)

SOLS, A . , M. L. SALAS, In Methods in Enzymology, (S. P. COLOWICK and N.O. KAPLAN, eds. ), Academic P r e s s , New York, vol. 9, (1966), 436

(22)

SALAS, M . L . , E. VINUELA, M. SALAS, A. SOLS, Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 19, (1965), 371

(23)

VINUELA, E . , M . L . SALAS, M. SALAS, A. SOLS, Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 15, (1964), 243

(24)

AFTING, E . G . , D. RUPPERT, H. HOLZER, this volume

(25)

SALAS, M. L . , J . SALAS, A. SOLS, Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 31, (1968), 461

(26)

FREYER, R . , S. LIEBE, G. KOPPERSCHLÄGER, E. HOFMANN, Eur. J. Biochem. (1970), 386

(27)

FREYER, R . , M. KUBEL, E. HOFMANN, Eur. J . Biochem. 17, (1970), 378

(28)

BAUMANN, P . , B. E. WRIGHT, Biochemistry 7, (1968), 3653

(29)

FERDINANDUS, J . , J . B . CLARK, Biochem. J . 113, (1969), 753

(30)

YOSHIDA, M., T. OSHIMA, K. IMAHGRI, Biochem. Biophys. Res.

(31)

LORENSON, M. Y . , T. E. MANSOUR, J . Biol. Chem. 244, (1969), 6420

Commun. 43, (1971), 36 (32)

PREISS, J . , T. KASUGA, Ann. Rev. Plant Physiol. 21, (1970), 433

(33)

ATKINSON, D . E . , Ann. Rev. Biochem. 35, (1966), 85

(34)

BLANGY, D. , H. BUC, J . MONOD, J . Mol. Biol. 31, (1968), 13

(35)

ATKINSON, D. E .York , In The Enzymes, P r e s s , New 1, (1970), 461 P. D. BOYER, ed., Academic

250

H

OH

H

SUBSTRATE

OH

INHIBITOR

Fig. 1. Qualitative comparison of the main requirements of brain hexokinase for hexose substrate and inhibitor hexosephosphate (6).

BRAIN HEXOKINASE EFFECT OF GLUCOSE 6-P CONCENTRATION ON THE RATE OF THE REVERSE REACTION

2

J_

J_

3

4

IGlucose 6-P1 (m M) Fig. 2. Inhibition of brain hexokinase in the r e v e r s e reaction by "excess substrate".

251 NUCLEOTIDE

SUBSTRATE OF

100

LIVER

AND

ALLOSTERIC

PYRUVATE



Diphosphates

0

Triphosphates

Q

"

SPECIFICITIES

KINASE

as

acceptors

( 1 mM. with

5

mM

PEP)

a s inhibitors ( 5 m M , w i t h 1 mM ADP a n d 0.25mM PEP) "

"

in presence

FDP (0.01 mM )

00

60 AO

...»

20 100 0.5

adenosine ATP trap : •

0.25

mM

« ,19 IB' '«A 19^ 65

69

guanosine

uridine

+

+

+

50 .26

72.

¡nosine +

PEP

Fig. 3. Differential specificity for nucleotide phosphates as substrates and inhibition of liver pyruvate kinase. OTP

1.5

2 (XTP)mU

Fig. 4. Specific inhibition of yeast phosphofructokinase by ATP. Trypsin attack

•©

( A ^

F6P

ATP,

(NHj)

Fig. 5. Model of the different adenylic nucleotide binding sites in yeast phosphofructokinase and their functional significance.

Enzymological Department, Institute of Biochemistry, Hungarian Academy of Sciences, Budapest

T. KELETI REGULATION OF ENZYMIC ACTIVITY BY INTRA- AND INTERSUBUNIT INTERACTIONS

Despite that the molecular mechanism of enzyme regulation was discovered on microbial enzymes and most of the known examples of regulatory enzymes a r e of microbial origin, glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase from mammalian muscle seems to be the "Noe's ark" a s far as this enzyme is endowed with almost all of the possible mechanisms of enzyme regulation. The regulation of enzymic activity manifests itself in two different levels; these are 1. intrasubunit and 2. intersubunit interactions. 1. Intrasubunit interactions operate between the active center and some physiological modifier bound either to the regulatory center or to an aspecific site of the same subunit. The physiological modifier may be the substrate or product or any metabolite in the cell. In the case of glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase two of the substrates inhibit (1-3), one of the substrates and a substrate analogue (4) activate the enzyme. The kinetic analysis of enzymological data shows that there are distinct substrate- and product-binding sites on the enzyme, furthermore, the substrate and product may be bound to the binding site of each other. The NAD bound to the NADH-binding site inhibits the rate of breakdown of substrate (Fig. 1). The excess of phosphate ion also inhibits the oxidative phosphorolysis of glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate. This inhibition is kinetically similar to the inhibition by excess NAD if the excess of phosphate is added in the assay mixture (3), however, the inhibition may be complete if the enzyme is preincubated with excess phosphate before the activity measurement (2, 5) (Fig. 2). The excess of both glyceraldehyde3-phosphate (1) and glyceraldehyde (4) activate the reaction catalyzed by glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase (Fig. 3). These data have recently been confirmed by KOSHLAND (6, 7).

254

NADH inhibits glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate oxidation in a parabolic competitive manner with respect to NAD (Fig. 4). Glyceric acid-3-phosphate, the analogue of the end-product glyceric acid-1, 3-diphosphate, also inhibits glyceraldehyde3-phosphate dehydrogenase and this inhibition is of the parabolic mixed type with respect to glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate (Fig. 5). These data can be interpreted as a consequence either of the existence of distinct substrate- and product-binding sites, where the substrate and product may be bound to either site and the substrate bound to the product-binding site serves as a modifier of the enzyme, or as a consequence of the existence of a regulatory center (3), which may be located outside the active center. In the former case the product-binding site plays the role of the regulatory center, whereas in the latter the regulatory center is topographycally independent of the active center. Although we cannot yet decide which of the above explanations holds, it has already been demonstrated that each glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase subunit binds two moles of NAD (7-9). The enzyme is inhibited by physiological modifiers such as adenine nucleotides: ATP, AMP, and adenine. As an example I mention the irreversible inhibition of glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase by ATP in the absence of mercaptoethanol, which is obviously formally non-competitive with NAD. However, the reversible inhibition in the presence of mercaptoethanol is of mixed type (10) (Fig. 6). This experiment suggests that ATP cannot be bound to the active center of the enzyme. It is assumed that the adenine nucleotides are bound to the regulatory center of the enzyme; indeed, this is confirmed by the suspension by these modifiers of the inhibition caused by both excess NAD and phosphate (3). These data will be presented in detail in this symposium by Mrs. OVADI. In our opinion a simple kinetic analysis is not sufficient to prove the existence of two types of binding sites on the same subunit. The method of double inhibitions provides valuable information on this problem. This method has been succesfully applied in case of double pure competitive inhibition with alcohol dehydrogenase (35) and some other enzymes. Since not in all cases can be found purely competitive inhibitors we have elaborated the generalized theory of double inhibitions considering all cases, when each of the two inhibitors is purely or partially competitive, non-competitive or uncompetitive with the substrate and does or does not interact with the other (36) (Fig. 7). The value of the interaction constant of the two inhibitors can be determined numerically when both substances give complete inhibition (pure inhibitions). If, however, one

255 or both inhibitors inhibit partially, only an approximate value of the interaction constant can be determined. In this case too, the method gives information not only on the binding-sites of substrate and the two inhibitors, but on the possible steric hindrance and steric changes in the enzyme induced by the substrate or inhibitors. We use this method, i . e . the double inhibition of glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase by excess NAD and ATP, where ATP is not a competitive inhibitor of the enzyme. Preliminary results indicate that each subunit of the enzyme contains two binding sites to which the coenzyme can be bound. 2. Intersubunit interactions, a. The "classic" allosterism. According to the symmetry postulate, a change in the steric structure of one subunit induces an analogous change in the other subunits of the oligomer. The two different forms of the oligomer can bind either the substrate or the modifier, but not both at the same time (11,12). b. The changes in the steric structure of one subunit caused by the substrate (induced fit (13,14) ) or by an inhibitor (induced misfit (15) ) cause a similar change in the structure of another subunit in the same oligomer, c. Some enzymes contain two different types of subunit: one can bind and transform the substrate, whereas the other binds only the modifier and thus regulates the activity of the oligomer (16). d. The flip-flap mechanism (17), which may be called an asymmetry postulate. Data characteristic of interactions between subunits may also be obtained without any interactions or even with monomeric enzymes, a. if a fluctuation fit is assumed, according to which enzyme molecules of different conformation are in equilibrium with each other and the binding of substrate or modifier shifts the equilibrium towards one or the other form stabilized by the ligand (18). b. if the enzyme can isomerize, follows steady-state kinetics and the substrate can bind to both forms of the enzyme (19); c. in the case of certain aggregates or populations of enzyme molecules containing fully active and partially damaged molecules. The differentiation of real and kinetically apparent interactions is very difficult. It is well known that the results of kinetic analyses are often difficult to interpret and alone they give only limited information. Unambiguous information can be obtained only by the exclusion of certain mechaisms. In spite of this, we can find in the literature such daring attempts, where a complete mechanism is suggested for an enzyme from one single type of experiment (e. g. a sigmoid saturation curve). A new approach to distinguish between allosteric interactions and pure kinetic causes of deviations from MICHAELIS-MENTEN kinetics was presented by BATKE (32).

256

The method is based on the analysis of specific activities of isoenzymes. Measuring the specific activity, one can avoid the uncertainties originating from the interpretation of sigmoidal saturation curves, since these a r e neither necessary nor an adequate criterion of allosteric interactions. In most cases it has been found that the number of the tetrameric isoenzymes is five, which is readily conceivable if two different subunits exist and their asymmetry is not detectable by the method used (see later). Since the interactions between subunits a and a, a and b,b and b may be different, the analysis of the specific activities of isoenzymes provides information on the allosteric interaction constants. When dissociation occurs, some of the interactions between the subunits are cancelled. Therefore we may expect that the changes of interactions between subunits are reflected in the specific activity of the enzyme molecule. This theoretical approach to determine allosteric interactions by the analysis of the specific activity of isoenzyme systems can also be applied to oligomeric enzymes having no isoenzymes, if their subunits can be modified separately, specifically and irreversibly and if the modification results In a significant change in the specific activity of the enzyme molecule (32). By separating the oligomers modified to different extents and measuring their specific activities one can estimate the type and degree of interactions, since the oligomers containing modified and unmodified subunits in different ratios may be considered a s isoenzymes. Moreover the kinetic analysis of the irreversible modification itself may provide useful information about the presence or absence of interactions between subunits (33) (Fig. 8). The kinetics of the irreversible modification of homotetrameric proteins show simple first order kinetics in the case of all-in-one mechanism. In this case there cannot be considerable interaction between the subunits. However, there must be a

strong interaction if the irreversible modification of the protein follows

the one intermediate mechanism. In this case the kinetics of the irreversible modification is identical with that of two consecutive first order reactions. If some modification of a protein follows the one-by-one mechanism we can determine whether the subunits a r e independent of each other or not. In this case it is possible to determine the fractional amounts of the different enzyme forms originally present in the protein preparation. It is possible to calculate interaction constants even if tetramer

** dimer or

d i m e r ^ ^ monomer dissociation occurs in the assay mixture. If dissociation

257

occurs, the analysis of activity or of any other parameter depending on the interaction, as a function of the concentration of tetramer form actually present in the solution, shows directly whether only the tetrameric or the dimeric form or both are active. The experiments performed with glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase confirm that: 1. there is a tetramer =5=!= dimer equilibrium in solution. 2. the enzyme is active both in the tetrameric and dimeric forms. 3. the subunits interact with each other (10, 39). The interaction between subunits depends also on the structure of the oligomer. In tetrameric molecules, theoretically, there are six possible arrangements of subunits: the tetrahedral, the plane, the cyclic, the stirrup, the triangel and the linear structure (37). As an example we present the possible isoenzymes in these six arrangements for a tetramer with two different subunits (Fig. 9). Due to theoretical considerations on symmetry and thermodynamics the most probable structure is the tetrahedral one. In this case each subunit must have three surfaces contacting the other three subunits in the tetramer. These contacting surfaces may be functionally identical, i. e. they contain approximately the same number of hydrophobic and or polar amino acids in similar arrangement or some or all of these are different. The subunits can be arbitrarily regarded as approximately symmetric or asymmetric. In fact, it is not reasonable to assume the existence of protein molecules which are strictly symmetric (geometrically, in charge distribution, etc.). However, it is possible to attribute an approximate symmetry to some protein molecules, the asymmetry of which cannot be detected, by the method used in the given experiment. Obviously, the approximate symmetry of a molecule is a relative term which changes with the development of methods. In other words we recognize isoenzymes if the asymmetry of subunits reaches the level of detection. If the asymmetry of only one of the two different subunits a and b is detectable we hay have 28 isoenzymes. If b subunit is asymmetric we have one a^, one a^b but six a^bg ^ individual isoenzymes and 2 stereoisomeric pairs, see Fig. 10), 11 abg (3 individual isoenzymes and 4 stereoisomeric pairs, see Fig. 11) and 9 b^ (3 individual isoenzymes and 3 stereoisomeric pairs, see Fig. 12). We obtain the same (9) isoenzymes in a^ and b^ as in the last case (Fig. 12) if the asymmetry of both a and b subunits is detectable. However, in the case of a,b and ab, we obtain 27 isoenzymes(3 individual ones and 12 stereoisomeric

258

pairs, see Fig. 13). In the case of agbg we have a camping site with 45 tents (3 individual isoenzymes and 21 stereoisomeric pairs, see Fig. 14), i. e. in this case the number of possible isoenzymes can be as high a s 117. Five isoenzymes can be isolated if two different protomers form tetrahedral tetramers and the asymmetry of subunits is not detectable by the method used. Only in this latter case can we apply the method of the analysis of specific activities of isoenzymes to detect allosteric interactions between subunits. Previous data show the existence of five isoenzymes in glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase. The analysis of interaction constants is in progress. There a r e certain findings which suggest that either allosteric interactions (20, 21) or induced fit (8,22) occurs in glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase. The existence of induced fit in the case of this enzyme is very probable since the binding of one substrate influences the binding of the others, i. e. the binding of substrate changes the structure of at least the active center (Table 1). Another evidence of structural changes is the stabilization of protein molecule by different substrates (24-88). This is also confirmed by thermodynamic data. The binding of NAD to the enzyme decreases the entropy of the complex as compared to the free enzyme (29). The stability of the enzyme-NAD complex is also reflected in the high activation energy of heat inactivation of tetrameric enzyme-coenzyme complex at the pH minimum of heat denaturation (30) (Fig. 15). However, these data merely show the changes in a subunit effected by the binding of coenzyme or substrate, but not the interaction between subunits. The phenomenon of induced misfit caused by ATP-inhibition or by maleylation provides evidence for the functional non-identity and interaction of subunits in glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase. Binding of 2 moles of ATP to the NAD-free tetrameric enzyme results in its inactivation. The same time course of inhibition was observed in the presence of 4 mole equivalents of ATP (10) (Fig. 16). The fact that no difference was found in the time course of inactivation with 2 or 4 ATP* s indicates that the subunits interact in the tetrameric molecule a s will be presented in details by Mrs. OVADI. Similarly, maleylation of 1 side chain of the NAD-free enzyme, or enzyme (NAD)^ complex completely inhibits the oxidation of glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate. The presence of the third and fourth, relatively loosely bound NAD's in the complex enzyme-(NAD)^ protects the enzyme against inactivation by maleylation (Fig. 17). The NAD-free maleylated tetrameric enzyme can bind only two moles of NAD, although the untreated enzyme binds all the four (10). These data also suggest that

259 Table 1 INTERACTIONS OF SUBSTRATES ON GLYCERALDEHYDE-3-PHOSPHATE DEHYDROGENASE a. COENZYMES determination

NAD %

kinetically with GAP and arsenate or GA and arsenate

S

l-6xl0"5

kinetically with GA and phosphate

kinetically with GSPP

2xl0"5

fluorimetrically, photometrically or with ultracentrifuge kinetically with GAP and phosphate or GA without anions

NADH

2x10" 7

0. 6-4xl0~ 7 l-2xl0"4

3xlC" 8

3x10®

b. SUBSTRATES GAP

determination KM

«s

GA KM

kinetically with arsenate

2-9x10"®-

lxio-1

kinetically with phosphate

5xl0" 4

5xl0"2

7x10"®

KS

KM

PO4" Kg

2xl0"2

kinetically with GAP

2xl0" 4 -

kinetically with GA

lxlO" 5 7 x l 0 " 5

there are interactions between the subunits and the subunit pair binding the relatively loosely bound NAD's plays an important role in these interactions. These data along with those showing the instantaneous firm binding of only two mole equivalents of ATP to the tetrameric enzyme (10), the reducibility of only two moles of firmly bound NAD at high enzyme concentrations (10, 31, 32), all seem to indicate the functional dissimilarity of subunits in glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase.

260

Since the thermodynamic parameters of enzymes in which subunit interactions occur may be different from those where such interactions are absent (34) it was of interest to analyze the thermodynamics of the reaction with various substrates. (38) From the Arrhenius plot of glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate oxidation under optimal conditions the activation energy of this reaction is about 12 kcal. / mole. We have shown that this value is a real activation energy since both the pH optimum of the reaction and the MICHAELE5 constants of NAD, glyc er aldehyde3-phosphate and phosphate ion remain unchanged if analyzed in the temperature range examined. The activation energy of glyceraldehyde oxidation is about 8 kcal. /mole. Since the chemical reaction is basically the same in both cases it may be assumed that the difference is due to changes in protein structure or to subunit interactions. The activation energy of the latter might be 1 kcal. per mole subunit. Inhibition by excess NAD or by ATP increases the activation energy of glyceraldehyde-3phosphate oxidation with about 4 kcal. /mole, whereas inhibition by excess phosphate, where not interaction between subunits was demonstrated does not change the activation energy of the reaction. The analysis of enthropy changes during the formation of activated complexes with NAD, glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate and phosphate ion gave a value of about -"22 cal. /degree/mole. This is in good agreement with the microcalorimetric measurements of the formation of enzymeNAD complex (29). As you can see we have made several attempts to sort out the regulation mechanisms from the many possible ones, which operate in glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase. In spite of our different theoretical and experimental approaches we cannot yet give a clear-cut picture of the regulatory aspects of this enzyme. Our efforts remind me of the man who asked the sage cadi how to cram his geese. The cadi said: "Feed them on ground crane feather. " The man came next day: "Cadi, 20 geese died. " "Well, said the cadi, then give them minced asbestos slate. " Again the man came next day: "Cadi, 40 geese died. " The cadi blinked: "Well, then give them chopped lime stone. " Next day the man rushed in upset: "Cadi, all geese died. " "Oh", said the cadi, "stroking his beard, "what a pity, when I have still so many good ideas. " Well, I also have a lot of good ideas how to study the mechanism of the regulation of glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase.

261 REFERENCES (1)

BATKE, J . , T. KELETI, Acta Biochim. Biophys. Acad. Sei. Hung. 3, (1968), 385

(2)

KELETI, T . , M. TELEGDI, Acta Physiol. Acad. Sei. Hung. 16, (1959), 235

(3)

OVADI, J . , M. NURIDSANY, T. KELETI, in preparation

(4)

KELETI, T . , Acta Physiol. Acad. Sei. Hung. 29, (1966), 101

(5)

SEVERIN, S. E . , N. K. NAGRADOVA, Dokl. Akad. Nauk SSSR 121, (1958), 519

(6)

CORNISH-BOWDEN, R . J . D . E . KOSHLAND, Biochemistry 9, (1970), 3325

(7)

SAPAG-HAGAR, M . , Rev. Esp. Fisiol. 25, (1969), 201

(8)

KOSHLAND, D . E . , R. A. COOK, A. CORNISH-BOWDEN, In H. SUND (ed.) Pyridine Nucleotide Dependent Dehydrogenases. Springer Verlag, Berlin, (1970), 199

(9)

CONWAY, A . , D . E . KOSHLAND, Biochemistry 7, (1968), 4011

(10)

OVADI, J . , M. TELEGDI, J . BATKE, T. KELETI, in preparation

(11)

MONOD, J . , J . P. CHANGEUX, F . JACOB, J . Mol. Biol. 6, (1963), 306

(12)

MONOD, J . , J . WYMAN, J . P. CHANGEUX, J . Mol. Biol. 12; (1965), 88

(13)

KOSHLAND, D . E . , Proc. Natl. Acad. Sei. U.S. 44, (1958), 98

(14)

KOSHLAND, D . E . , Adv. Enzymol. 22, (1960), 45

(15)

GERHART, J . C . , A . B . PARDEE, J . B i o l . Chem. 237, (1962), 891

(16)

GERHART, J . C . , H. K. SCHACHMAN, Biochemistry 4, (1965), 1054

(17)

LAZDUNSK2, M . , Battelle Symp. on Mol. B a s i s of Biol. Spec, and Control Mech. Seattle, 1970 (and private commun.)

(18)

STRAUB, F . B . , G. SZABOLCSI, In Molekül. Biol. Izd. Nauka, Moskva (1964), 182

(19)

KELETI, T . , Acta Biochim. Biophys. Acad. Sei. Hung. 3, (1968), 247

(20)

KIRSCHNER, K . , M. EIGEN, R. BITTMAN, B . VOIGT, Proc. Natl. Acad. S e i . U . S . 56, (1966), 1661

(21)

KIRSCHNER, K . , I. SCHUSTER, In H. SUND (ed.) Pyridine Nucleotide Dependent Dehydrogenases. Springer Verlag, Berlin. (1970), 217

(22)

LEVITZKI, A . , D . E . KOSHLAND, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sei. U. S. 62, (1969), 1121

(23)

KELETI, T . , In DEVENYI, T . , P. ELÖDI, T. KELETI, G. SZABOLCSI, Strukturelle Grundlagen der biologischen Funktion der Proteine. Akadfemiai Kiadö, Budapest (1969), 317

(24)

ELÖDI, P . , G. SZABOLCSI, Nature 184, (1959), 56

(25)

LISTOWSKY, I . , C. S. FURFINE, J . J . B E T E I L , S. ENGLARD, J . B i o l . Chem. 240, (1965), 4253

262 (26)

KELETI, T . , J . BATKE, Acta Physiol. Acad. Sci. Hung. 28, (1965), 195

(27)

DEVENYI, T . , P. ELCDI, T. KELETI, G. SZABOLCSI, Biol. Kozl. 8, (1960), 3

(28)

VAS, M., L. BOROSS, private communication

(29)

VELICK, S. F . , J . P. BAGGOTT, J . M. STURTEVANT, Biochemistry 10, (1971), 779

(30)

KELETI, T . , M. SZEGVARI, In preparation

(31)

BATKE, J . , FEBS Letters 2, (1968), 81

(32)

BATKE, J . , In preparation

(33)

KELETI, T . , J . Theoret. Biol. 30, (1971), 545

(34)

NOBLE, R . W . , J.Mol.Biol. 39, (1969), 479

(35)

YONETANI, T . , H. THEORELL, Arch. Biochem. Biophys. 106, (1964), 243

(36)

KELETI, T . , Cs. FAJSZI, Mathemat. Biosci. in press (1971)

(37)

FAJSZI, C s . , T. KELETI, In preparation

(38)

KELETI, T . , J . FOLDI, S. ERDEI, T. TRO, In preparation

(39)

BATKE, J . , Studia Biophysica 25, (1970), 187

263

Fig. 1. The NAD-saturation curve of glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase. Experimental conditions see réf. 1. W' Z[NAD]M

Fig. 2. The phosphatesaturation curve of glyceraldehyde -3 -phos phate dehydrogenase. Experimental conditions see references 2 and 3.

•D

preincubated 4

5

6

{Wt~\M-102

Fig. 3. The substrate-saturation curves of glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase. Experimental conditions see references 1 and 4. 4.0[6A]M10~ 2

7

264

[NAQ]M , 0.25-10 0.5W4 0.75W4

[NAD]

JO 20 , [NADHj M-105

Fig. 4. The inhibition of glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase by NADH. Experimental conditions see réf. 1.

Fig. 5. The inhibition of glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase by glyceric acid-3-phosphate. Experimental conditions see réf. 1.

265 hours of

Fig. 6. LINEWEAVER-BURK plot of the inhibition of glyceraldehyde-3phosphate dehydrogenase by ATP. Incubation was performed with 4 mole equivalents of ATP/mole of protein.

Fig. 7. Scheme of the general mechanism of double inhibitions. Broken lines show the elementary steps where the substrate and one of the inhibitors may interact; double lines, where the two inhibitors interact on the free enzyme; dotted lines, where the two inhibitors interact on the enzyme-substrate complex. The encircled symbols indicate complexes from which the product is formed.

266

oo

••

OO

••

Fig. 8. All-in-one, one intermediate and one-by-one mechanism of irreversible modification of tetrameric proteins, o: native subunit; • : modified subunit.

âj

djb

azbz

MUM

s

p7t naaaa » • nan. JUiJU, J* A JL

XXAkX"

Fig. 9. Possible arrangements and number of isoenzymes of tetrameric molecules.

267

Ay Fig. 10. Isoenzymes of a2b 2 if b subunit is asymmetric.

AA

AA

^k J^k -jilk Fig. 11. Isoenzymes of abg if b subunit is asymmetric.

268

Fig. 12. Isoenzymes of homotetrameric enzyme if the. subunits are asymmetric.

4444 44 44 44 * A 9 Fig. 13. Isoenzymes of a^b or abg if both subunits are asymmetric.

269

Fig. 14. Isoenzymes of a_b„ if both subunits are asymmetric.

Fig. 15. Heat denaturation of glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase. Left: pH dependence of the first order rate constant of inactivation at 50 °C, 1 mg enzyme/ml glycin buffer. Right: Arrhenius plot of heat inactivation at pH 6.1,7. 7 and 8.4, giving 112, 130 and 82 kcal. /mole activation energy, resp.

270 ì £ 60-

1 40-

_L 60

_L

120

700

240

300

min.

Fig. 16. Inactivation of glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase by ATP. Experimental conditions see ref. 10. x: 2 moles, *:4 moles of ATP +: without ATP.

1

2 bound matey/groups

3 (motes/mote

4 of

_L

5 subunit)

6

Fig. 17. Inactivation of glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase by maleylation. Experimental conditions see ref. 10. o, • , A : enzyme-NAD^; • ,x, jf : enzyme-NAD_ and free enzyme. SOr 40

2

' >517 I S ri

20

Fig. 18. Arrhenius plot of glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate oxidation. —I

3.2

1

3.3

1— 7

3.4

J

1

3

m 0

The Department of Physiological Chemistry, The University of Würzburg

J . EHRLICH, K. FELDMANN, E. HELMREICH, T. PFEUFFER THE FUNCTION OF PYRIDOXAL-5' -PHOSPHATE IN GLYCOGEN PHOSPHORYLASE

PLP is essential for the activity of all known oc-glucan phosphorylases (FISCHER et al. (1)). The first Phosphorylase enzyme shown to contain PLP was rabbit skeletal muscle Phosphorylase a(BARANOWSKI et al. (2)). On removal of PLP - one mole per monomer of 100, 000 daltons(SEERY et al. (3) and Fischer, personal communication (1970)) - an inactive crystalline apoenzyme was obtained which regained its activity upon addition of PLI> ILLINGWORTH et al. (4). In the rabbit, there is more PLP bound to muscle Phosphorylase than to all other PLP dependent enzymes taken together, FISCHER and KREBS (5). FISCHER et al. (6,7) found that PLP bound to Phosphorylase a s an imine through its 4 formyl group to an e -amino group of a lysyl residue can be reduced with NaBH^ to a secondary amine, but only after the PLP binding region of the protein is reversibly "deformed" for example by acidification or high salt concentrations, GRAVES et al. (8). The reduced enzyme still retains about 60 % of its original activity. This rules out a participation of the # 4-formyl group of PLP in Phosphorylase catalysis. The 4-formyl group of PLP is the functional group in every other PLP dependent enzyme,SNELL (9). Ever since, the function of PLP in Phosphorylase poses a challenging puzzle to enzymologists, because, if PLP should actually participate in the reaction catalyzed by the glycogen phosphorylases, it must do that through functional groups other than the 4-formyl group. Undoubtedly, PLP is a molecule tailored for a function as proton shuttle(JENCKS (10)). Thus it could substitute for functional groups of amino acid side chains and participate in general acid-base catalysis. Kinetic measurements with the temperatur jump method by AHRENS et al. (11) showed that substituted 3-hydroxypyridine-4-aldehydes lacking the 5' -phosphate group transfer protons in water between the ring nitrogen and the ôxygen in position 3 mainly by an intermolecular route. On introduction of the phosphate group in 5' -position an additional intramolecular proton transfer occurs involving 3 rather than 2 prqton-donor acceptor groups.

274 In order to see whether P L P could participate as proton shuttle in the Phosphorylase reaction all 3 protonatable groups have been modified: 3' -O-Me PLP was synthesized and found to reactivate apophosphorylaseto20to25% as compared with PLP, POCKER and FISCHER (12), SHALTIEL et al. (13). Thus the phenolic OH group is not essential for activity. The nucleophilic pyridinium nitrogen of PLP (PJJ 8- 7) is another functional group. In the NO derivatives of PLP or 3' -O-MePLP, protonation of the nitrogen is blocked. The NO derivative of PLP was prepared by FUKUI et al. (14). In addition we have synthesized the N-oxide of 3' -O-Me PLP. The synthetic procedure is outlined in Fig. 1. It is already known since 1958 from the work of CORP s group(ILLINGWORTH et al. (15))that the phosphate group of PLP does not exchange with Pi or glucose1-P, the anionic substrates of Phosphorylase. Recently we suggested the 5' -phosphate group of PLP (p K 6. 2) as a candidate for a catalytically functional group in Phosphorylase, in analogy with the function of the carboxyl group of aspartate 52 in lysozyme (KASTENSCHMIDT et al. (16)). In order to block the phosphate group with p K 6. 2 of PLP the PL-5' -P-monomethylester was prepared. The p r e parative procedure is summarized in Fig. 2. In order to prove unequivocally that one or the other protonatable group of PLP actually participates in the chemical reaction catalyzed by Phosphorylase one must show that an inactive analogue can reconstitute a Phosphorylase enzyme with the same or a very similar active site conformation as active PLP Phosphorylase. This i s necessary because in an enzyme, conformationally as flexible as Phosphorylase, the proper fit of the prosthetic group to the enzyme and its conformational stabilization seem a prerequisite for its catalytic function. Results The role of the pyridinium nitrogen BRESLER and FIRSOV (17) had assigned a role to the ring nitrogen of PLP in Phosphorylase catalysis. Differential spectroscopy of Phosphorylase b at high concentrations ( » 20 mg/ml) in the presence of Pi or glucose-l-P indicated the appearance of a new maximum at 360 nm with a minimum at 330 nm. This was interpreted a s indicating the formation of an ion pair between the pyridinium nitrogen of PLP and one of the negatively charged groups of Pi or glucose-l-P. This however, is very unlikely. FISCHER et al. (18) stated evidence which strongly argues against the proposal that the 360 nm absorbancy is indicating

275

the formation of an enzyme substrate complex. Its appearance is more likely due to a conformational transition induced by the substrates which affects the interaction of PLP with neighbouring amino-acid side chains. The N-Me derivative of PLP was prepared by POCKER and FISCHER. However, the N-Me PLP does not bind to apophosphorylase, presumably because of steric hindrance, electrostatic repulsion by the positively charged nitrogen or both (SHALTIEL et al. (13)). We have substantiated this conclusion by chemical analysis. In contrast to N-Me PLP, NO-PLP binds to apophosphorylase b. Precautions must be taken however: PLP-NO is photoreactive. The reaction of PLP-N-O with apophosphorylase must be carried out in the dark and in the absence of oxygen. Reconstitution of apophosphorylase b with PLP-NO at 30°C at a molar ratio of 1. 5 to 2:1 yielded an enzyme preparation with an activity of 20 to 25 % of that of the PLP reconstituted enzyme. This was also noted by FISCHER et al. (1,18). We now could show that partial reactivation of apophosphorylase b is due to PLP formed by the reaction of apophosphorylase with PLP-NO. Use was made of the spectral differences between PLP-NO and PLP. (Fig. 3). PLP-NO at neutral and alkaline pH has a strong absorbancy at 295 nm. At pH 7. 0, 6 = 9. 800. PLP in this pH range lacks the 295 nm band. The disappearance of the 295 nm band provides therefore a convenient means to measure quantitatively the deoxygenation of PLP-NO. The deoxygenation of PLP-NO to PLP by apophosphorylase b is complete in 2 min at 30°C. It is rather specific: Neither lysozyme which has many lysyl groups or eggalbumin which has many SH groups did deoxygenate PLP-NO at comparable rates, nor did L-cysteine, 2-mercaptoethanol, lysine or e -aminocaproic acid. This then poses the questions: 1. Which aminoacid side chain specifically reduces PLP-NO in apophosphorylase and 2. does this reaction take-place at the PLP specific binding site? PLP-NO phosphorylase b and PLP phosphorylase were reacted in 50 mM glycero-Pbuffer pH 6. 8 with dithio-bis nitrobenzoic acid ELLMAN (20), using conditions previously described by KASTENSCHMEDT et al. (16). Under these conditions only two exposed cysteinyl residues per monomer b form a mixed disulfide with DTNB in native phosphorylase b. Reaction of these two cysteinyl residues does neither affect catalytic activity or quarternary structure of phosphorylase b. A comparison of the SH reactivity of PLP and PLP-NO phosphorylases revealed

276

that for each mole of PLP formed a mole of SH becomes unreactive with DTNB (Fig. 4). This is a minimum estimate, because we would have missed SH groups which are reactive in native phosphorylase b only with alkylating agents or with DTNB at higher molar excess or which become reactive only on denaturation of the protein. Conceivably, additional SH groups not reactive with DTNB under the conditions of our experiments might take part in the deoxygenation of PLP-NO. Deoxygenation of PLP-NO by an SH group of the phosphorylase protein could lead to the formation of a disulfide via an intermediary sulfenic acid. Oxidation of a thiol to a sulfenic acid would be consistent with the 1:1 stoichiometry of loss of SH versus PLP formed. As is evident from Fig. 4 reduced PLP phosphorylase b with PLP irreversibly attached to the protein also reacts with PLP-NO. However, compared with apophosphorylase b reduced phosphorylase forms only half a s much PLP and correspondingly loses half a s many SH. This suggests that the deoxygenation reaction of PLP-NO—»PLP does not take place, at least not exclusively, at the PLP specific site. The cysteinyl residue that reacts with PLP-NO does not need to be involved directly in the binding of PLP and the assembly of the active site. It is more likely that the cysteinyl residue encounters the PLP-NO at some phase during the complicated structural transitions following the binding of PLP to apophosphorylase. In view of the deoxygenation of PLP-NO to PLP by the phosphorylase protein, it was desirable to look for a stable analogue of PLP with an unprotonatable nitrogen in the pH range in which phosphorylase is active. For this purpose 3' -O-Me PLP-NO was synthesized. Although it is bound to apophosphorylase b, it is stable. Experiments in Table 1 show that reconstitution of the apoprotein with 3' -O-Me PLP-NO yielded an inactive enzyme. The cofactor of which 0. 9 to 0. 95 moles per 100, 000 daltons of phosphorylase were bound to the protein was resolved and identified by paper electrophoresis in formic acid a s the original 3' -O-Me PLP-NO. After removal of 3' -O-Me PLP-NO and a second cycle of reconstitution of the apoprotein - this time with PLP- a phosphorylase was obtained with 96 % of the specific activity of reconstituted active holophosphorylase b.

277

s

bfi e I

«

ft

S3 J O CL M H " * "

'S

O ra

co Ol

co co Q) CT

"S

S O H BS

S

t» e *-* « H i

S

S S a-5 H •2 »

-S °

S ® •S 0] "S g

8

M

«

e

3.3 S-s u o « « ® d q, G

^

.S

*

a

» o

S

JS S O

o

O 0) o

ci

O



6 h

-

;

*

s L

-

> > ¡ £ |

ö «

s

fi g

8

l

l

S

O

K O) w

«

•S 4 M

i < ft J ft ÌH

5

a

a - p á « S a. « w


a

a) bûS fcî O s

\ S ho >. o s

p

i

ä - j

l fe

i 5

e

S ÌH «

¿ r a

g ^ S - s t î S ^

o)

° a)

g h CO

i—I « H

O «

S S

ft

3

°

2


to

O

§

£ S

ft

E*

•J

g H O •s H

«

ft bß O

V

ft ft

s

< u I — I >>

I

s

o e 0

s

1

d-3

2

o

fi

5

'

01

S

ftrt

£•s ïï en iß *

1

s

-a « ï

s

_ .S? ® < » s-

S

g

"S

s

? ^ **.—to % & i; ö u

^ H

1
l x 10 - 1 M

> 2 xlO " 2 M 9. 3 x 10 " 3 M

n = 3

L

c = 4 x 10- 3

0

= 3900

On the basis of the molecular weight of 190000 a Scatchard plot calculates approximately 3. 6 binding sites for FDP per native enzyme which in extrapolation points to four binding sites (42). Here, we encounter a serious discrepancy between the structural and binding data and the result of the steady-state analysis. The first technique clearly indicates that we are dealing with an enzyme composed of four subunits and probably of four active binding sites for FDP. The latter technique yields only three. Indeed, we a r e dealing with the same problem which is observed in the case of hemoglobin, in which a n „ of approximately 2. 6 and 4 protomers n f QioX are reported (46). In the logic of our analytical procedure of fig. 3 the HILL-coefficient a s a function of the model parameter is a basic and quantitative relationship, which is unique only in the case of ideal two-state systems. Since a deviation of the number of protomers (n) is observed, the presence of hybride states is suggested. In order to cover the occurance of hybride states such a s R.T l n-i., which are not recognized in the original model of MONOD, WYMAN and CHANGEUX (39), the equation, which relates the well-known HILL-coefficient with the model parameter oc. / 0 , n and c was modified by addition of a weighting for a number of protomers 2

2

(n) by a quotient d / 0 1 6 equation relates the experimental Hillcoefficient and KQ g with the model parameter n, Kj^g) and K j . ^ . Only if ^ V ^ ^ = 1 is all or non behaviour observed. As shown in fig. 5a deviation factor of 0. 07 from the ideal curvature was found in the case of n = 3, i. e. with three protomers per enzyme. If the same fit is carried out with four protomers per mole enzyme, a factor of 0. 38 pointing to the form of R T i n - i w e r e computed from the experimental analysis of the steady-state kinetic in agreement with the chemical data. Since the trimeric model does not agree with the chemical properties of the enzyme it has no priority. Thus we postulate an additional hybride state participating within the equilibrium, a s demonstrated in the following reaction scheme:

The consequence of this interpretation is the change of the allosteric constant from 3900 to 60000. It should be stressed here, that such a weighting does not change the values for K^ T or the non-exclusive binding coefficient. Allowing for the hybride states and four protomers an excellent fit of the experimental saturation function can be obtained using the appropriate L' -values a s given in Fig. 9. Thus, macroscopically no difference can be detected in case of three protomers compared to the case of four protomers including hybride states. Thus, interpretation of steady-state kinetics by classical means do not allow unique conclusions about molecular mechanisms involved, if no complementary information on the molecules are available. The thermodynamic paramters derived for the models are summarized in Table 6 for the case of n = 4 (L q (4)) as well as n = 3 (L q (3)). It is obvious from the AG°-values that the transition from the T-state to the R-state is an extremely large step, which is expected to be carried through in a series of small transitions such a s indicat ed by the assumption of a hybride state, and even more intermediary states might be discovered in the future.

496 Table 6 pH = 7. 0 L -Werte 0 L ( 4 ) = 60000

T = 25°C -AG0

kcal/Mol 6.5

L ^ 0 2H

= 3900 = 490

4.9 3.7

H/2

=

2.9

123

Within such a time-scale inhomogeneities of the transition can scarcely be detected. However, it is hoped that more sophisticated techniques will differentiate the conformation change in more detail (33). A discussion of the structural consequences of this model is out of the scope of this presentation. However, I would like to mention a kinetic experiment, which demonstrates the time-scale of the transient of the enzyme shifting from the T - to the R-state. As demonstrated above the various states of pyruvate kinase of yeast can directly be recognized by recording the tryptophane fluorescence of the native enzyme in the presence and absence of ligands. Recent experiments with a stoppedflow technique recording fluorescence changes on rapid mixing of native pyruvate kinase with FDP revealed, that the activation time of the fluorescence change is completed whithin the mixing time of the instrument of about 1. 5 msec. Physiology An evaluation of the properties of pyruvate kinase under physiological conditions is important for our understanding of the operation of the enzyme within the intact glycolytic system. We therefore analyzed overall kinetic parameters of pyruvate kinase over a large concentration range. In such a study it was found that a clear proportionality of pyruvate kinase of rabbit muscle in the -9 -6 concentration range between 10 - 10 M is found. There is no significant concentration dependency over a wide concentration range up to physiological levels of the activity of the enzyme (47). Furthermore, the transient time of pyruvate kinase related to the Michaelis-constant for ADP and V m a x of the enzyme was found concentration-independent in the range between 10"° - 10"° M (47). Finally a recent analysis of the yeast enzyme again demonstrated a concentration independency of the specific activity of the enzyme in the range between

497

10

6

2. 5 x 10" M up to 5 x 10 M pyruvate kinase of yeast (Fig. 10 (48) ). These results demonstrate that there is a good reason to assume that analytical studies on enzymes in diluted state can be extrapolated to the highly concentrated state of the enzyme under physiological conditions and no dissociation - association equilibria need to be considered with this enzyme. Finally I would like to point to the physiological significance of a regulation of pyruvate kinase by fructose-1, 6-diphosphate in S. cerevisiae. Barwell and coworkers recently have analyzed the conditions under which a crossover behaviour of phosphoenolpyruvate and pyruvic acid together with the inverse relationship in companion with a changing concentration of fructose-1, 6-diphosphate can directly be related to the activity of pyruvate kinase (49).

REFERENCES (1)

McQUATE, J . T . , M.F. UTTER, J. Biol. Chem.

234, (1959), 2151

(2)

DECKER, K., C. BARTH, H. METZ, Biochem. Z. 345, (1966), 472

(3)

MAEBA, P . , B.D. SANWAL, J. Biol. Chem.

(4)

HESS, B., In: B. CHANCE, R.W. ESTABROOK, J . R . WILLIAMSON, Control of Energy Metabolism, Academic P r e s s New York, (1965)

(5)

HESS, B., R. HAECKEL, K. BRAND, Biochem. Biophys. Res. Communs. 24, (1966), 824

(6)

HAECKEL, R . , B. HESS, W. LAUTERBORN, i t H. WÜSTER, HoppeSeyler' s Z. Physiol. Chem. 349, (1968), 699 TAYLOR, C.B., E. BAILEY, Biochem. J. 102, (1967), 32C TANAKA, T . , F. SUE, H. MORIMURA, Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 29, (1967), 444

(7) (8) (9)

243, (1968), 448

KUTZBACH, C., B. HESS, Hoppe-Seyler's Z. Physiol. Chem. 351, (1970), 272

(10)

POGSON, C . I . , Biochem. Biophys. Res. Communs. 30, (1968), 297

(11)

MUNRO, G. F (1970), 87. , D.R. MILLER, Biochemica et Biophysica Acta 206,

(12)

MALCOVATI, M., H. L. BÖRNBERG, Biochemica et Biophysica Acta 178, (1969), 420

498

(13)

TANAKA, Y. HARANO, F. SUE, H. MORIMURA, J . Biochem. Tokyo, 62, (1967), 71

(14)

TANAKA, T . , Y. HARANO, H. MORIMURA, R. MORI, Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun., 21, (1965), 55

(15)

KREBS, H . A . , L.V. EGGLESTON, Biochem. J . , 94, (1965), 3C

(16)

WEBER, G., Regulation of Pyruvate Kinase in Advances in Enzyme Regulation 7, (1969), 15

(17)

BISCHOFBERGER, H., B. HESS, P. RÖSCHLAU, Hoppe-Seyler's Z. Physiol.

(18)

STEINMETZ, M. A . , W. C. DEAL, Biochemistry 5, (1966), 1399

(19)

HESS, B . , C. KUTZBACH, H. BISCHOFBERGER, in preparation

(20)

KUCZENSKI, R. T . , C. H. SUELTER, Biochemistry 9, (1970), 2043

(21)

ASHTON, K., A. R. PEACOCKE, personnel communication

(22)

STAAL, G. E. J . , J . F. KÖSTER, H. KAMP, L. van MILLIGEN-BOERSMA, C. VEEGER, Biochem. Biophys. Acta 227, (1971), 86

(23)

BLUME, K.G., R.W. HOFFBAUER, D. BUSCH, H. ARNOLD, G.W. LOHR, Biochem. Biophys. Acta 227, (1971), 364

(24)

TERENZI, H . F . , E. ROSELINO, S. PASSERSON, Europ. J . Biochem. 18, (1S71), 342

(25)

CARMINATTI, H., L. JIMENEZ DE ASUA, E. RECONDO, S. PASSERU, E. ROZENGURT, J.Biol. Chem. 243, (1968), 3051

(26)

WIEKER, H . J . , K . J . JOHANNES, B. HESS, Abstract FEBS-Congress of Madrid, (1969), 138

(27)

HAMMES, G . G . , J . SIMPLICIO, Biochemica et Biophysica Acta 212, (1970), 428

(28)

MILDVAN, A. S., M.COHN, Advances in Enzymology 33, (1970), 1

(29)

HESS, B . , P. RÖSCHLAU, L. BORNMANN, unpublished experiments

(30) (31)

HUNSLEY. J . R . , C. H. SUELTER, J . Biol. Chem. 244, (1969), 4815 BISCHOFSBERGER, H., B. HESS, P. RÖSCHLAU, H. - J . WIEKER, H. ZIMMERMANN-TELSCHOW, Hoppe-Seyler' s Z, Physiol. Chem. 351, (1970), 401

Chem. 352, (1971), 1139

(32)

SUÈLTER, C. H., personnel communication

(33)

HESS, B . , R. MÜLLER, unpublished experiments

(34)

WIEKER, H. - J . , B. HESS, This symposium

(35)

SUELTER, C . H . , Biochemistry 6, (1967), 418

(36)

HESS, B . , C. KUTZBACH, Hoppe-Seyler' s Z. Physiol. Chem. 352, (1971), 453

(37)

JIMENEZ DE ASUA, L. , E. ROZENGURT, H. CARMINATTI, FEBSL e t t e r s ^ 4 , (1971), 22

(38)

IBSEN, K.H., K.W. SCHILLER, T. A. HAAS, J. Biol. Chem. 246, (1971), 1233

499 (39)

MONOD, J . , J . WYMAN, J . P. CHANGEUX, J . Mol. Biol. 12, (1965), 88

(40)

BLANGY, D . , H. BUC, J . MONOD, J . Mol. Biol. 31, (1968), 13

(41)

WIEKER, H . - J . , K . - J . JOHANNES, B. HESS, F E B S - L e t t e r s 8, (1970), 178

(42)

HESS, B . , K . J . JOHANNES, H. BUC, in preparation

(43)

BUC, H . , Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun., 28, (1967), 59

(44)

BORN, A . , H. BÖRNIG, FEBS-Letters 3, (1870), 73

(45)

ENDRENYI, L . , M.S. CHAN, J. TZE-SEIWONG, personnel communications

(46)

PERUTZ, M . F . , Nature 228, (1970), 726

(47)

HESS, B . , B. WURSTER, FEBS-Letters 9, (1870), 73

(48)

BARWELL, C . , B. HESS, unpublished experiments

(49)

BARWELL, C . , B. WOODWARD, R. V. BRUNT, Europ. J . Biochem. 18, (1971), 59

500

501

Fig. 3. Logic of kinetic analysis.

Fig. 4. Y-function.

502

Fig. 5 and 6. For explanation see text.

503

Fig. 7. Fluorescence emission spectra of pyruvat kinase of S. carlsbergensis. p = polarisaison. The incident and scattered light is vertically polarized by means of a filter.

Fig. 8. For explanation see text. Ordinate: relative units, abscissa: FDP concentration in nmolar.

504

Fig. 9. Coiputer fit(—and—)of a saturation curve of pyruvate kinase of S. carlsbergensis. For explanation see text.

log [PK-Molarity]Fig. 10. Relation between activity and molarity of pyruvate kinase of S. carlsbergensis. The o and • -values are obtained with an Eppendorfphotometer and stoppend-flow technique respectively.

Max-Planck-Institut für Ernährungsphysiologie, Dortmund

H.J. WIEKER, B. HESS pH - FUNCTION AND ALLOSTERIC CONTROL OF YEAST PYRUVATE KINASE

In another presentation (see'B. HESS et al.) the effects of some metabolites on the allosteric properties of yeast pyruvate kinase were demonstrated, especially the activation by fructose - 1, 6 -diphosphate (FDP). Here the effects of another ligand which is an essential factor in enzymic reactions will be discussed, the H+-ion. The aim of our studies on the pH-dependence of yeast pyruvate kinase reaction was to differentiate the effects of H + -ions into their effects on the catalytic process, on the binding of substrate and especially on the allosteric properties of this enzyme. Such a differentiation will be possible by determining the pH -functions of the kinetic parameters "maximal velocity" (Vmax ), reflecting

catalysis, "half saturation constant" (Kg g), correlated to substrate binding, and "interaction coefficient" or "Hill coefficient" (nH) reflecting cooperativity. In order to obtain these parameters and functions, reaction velocities were measured a s a function of the concentration of phosphoenolpyruvate (PEP) between pH 5 and 9. 5. The concentrations of the second substrate, ADP, and the 2+

+

essential Mg - and K -ions were kept constant. In addition, the pH -dependence of the activated enzyme was measured in the presence of FDP. (The corresponding parameters are symbolyzed by the index "(FDP)", e.g. KQ 5(pj)p)-) Thus, a series of twenty substrate saturation curves (v vs. s) were obtained, each consisting of twenty-five v-values. These curves were sigmoidal in the absence and hyperbolic in the presence of FDP. Curves of these types can be described with a minimum of parameters and without any preinterpretation by models for allosteric enzymes according to v

=

_Vrnax_ 1 +(^)UH

506 Using a special computer program (for details see WIEKER et a l . ; FEBS-Letters 8 (1970), 178) the kinetic parameters n„, K_ _ and V were determined for xi u. o max each saturation curve with a mean standard deviation of + 5 %. They are plotted a s n f l (Fig. 1), pKQ g (Fig. 2) and log V m a x (Fig. 3) as functions of pH. These functions have now to be analyzed in terms of acid dissociation constants (pK a -values). The commonly used graphical method of Dixon was not applicable to our data, because it leads to very erroneous results if the pK a ~values are not sufficiently seperated from each other. Therefore, on the basis of the Dixonscheme, we developed a computer program, by which the pKA -values could be determined by a trial and error-procedure with a variation of + 0. 05 pH-units. (For a detailed description see H. -J. WIEKER and B. HESS: Biochemistry 10 (1971), 1243). The most striking difference in the pH-dependencies of the nonactivated and the activated enzyme is found for the "interaction coefficient" (Fig. 1): while n jj(j>j)p) is pH independent with a mean value of n jj(jr£)p) = O5 n j j increase with pH and reaches above pH 7 a limiting, pH-independent value of n^ = 2. 95. The curve was obtained by computing a somewhat modified pH-function of a monobasic acid with a rpK =5. 35. a As n H and " j j ^ j j p y the "half-saturation constants" (Fig. 2) also merge to the same value at low pH. Below pH 7, where n H is pH-dependent, the curves of KQ g and Kg 5(pjjp)

are

divergent, but they run parallel above pH 7, where n H

becomes pH-independent. The curves are computed according to the Dixon-scheme with the pK a -values given in the figure. The straight lines with zero or + one unit slope a r e constructed with these pK^-values, and it becomes obvious that - in this case - the graphical method of Dixon would lead to very erroneous results and is not applicable. These results show a striking analogy to the activation by FDP: with increasing concentration of H + -ions n^ decreases and Kq g and Kq

merge to the same value. As a merely qualitative result we can

conclude that H + -ions diminish or even abolish the cooperative behaviour of yeast pyruvate kinase. In contrast to these figures the pH-dependencies of V111 3.X (Fig. 3) are not significantly altered by the allosteric activator FDP. Both curves are not computed and no pK a ~values are determined, for the asymmetries necessitate more complex pH-functions for their computation, but the results would not be interpretable at the moment. Nevertheless, these curves lead to the following informations on the catalytic

507 process: The alterations of the allosteric properties caused by FDP a r e not accompanied by alterations at the catalytic site of the enzyme. At least two ionizing groups are involved in the catalytic process, one in its deprotonated form, the other in its protonated form; their pK a -values can be estimated to be in the region of 5. 5 and 8, resp. In case of an allosteric enzyme, Kq g (Fig. 2) cannot be simply interpreted with respect to the binding process, because it also reflects cooperativity. However, from n jj(pDp) = 1 it follows, that there is no cooperativity in the presence of FDP, and Kq g (fDP)

reflects the binding properties of the activated

enzyme. Therefore, we can apply the method of Dixon: according to the mathematical treatment, two pK & -values, namely pK a ^ = 5.45 and p K ^ = 9. 0, correspond to ionizing groups of the free enzyme, and two pK -values, namely a pK a g = 4, 8 and p K ^ = 8. 35, correspond to the enzyme substrate complex. (It can be excluded that pK a ^ and p K ^ refer to dissociation constants of the f r e e substrate PEP, for they a r e found to be 3.4 - 3. 5 (carboxyle) and 6. 35 - 6.40 (phosphate).) Thus, two groups a r e involved in the binding of PEP. Bouth groups can also ionize in the enzyme substrate complex, and their acidity is increased, for their pK -values a r e decreased from 5.45 to 4. 8 and from 9. 0 to 8. 35. a Furthermore, a s n^ becomes pH-independent above pH 7, the pH-dependence of Kq g is not influenced by cooperativity at higher pH. The existence of a group with pK a 2 = 9. 0, shifted to p K ^ = 8.4, indicates that the ionization properties of this group are not influenced by the allosteric activator FDP. As demonstrated in another communication (see B. HESS), FDP shifts the equilibrium between R- and T-state to the more activ R-state and this shift is accompanied by a decrease of n^ to the limiting value of n jj(pjjp) = 1- Thus, n^j can be regarded a s a quantity reflecting such allosteric transitions. Therefore we conclude from the pH -dependence of n^ (Fig. 1) that H + -ions also shift this equilibrium to the state of higher affinity and that the T-state is converted into the R-state by protonation of a group with a pKA = 5. 35: pK = 5.35 R •» T + H This conversion decreases the cooperativity a s well a s that caused by FDP, i. e. H + -ions must be regarded a s allosteric activators of yeast pyruvate kinase. Furthermore, a s n jj(pQp) is pH-independent and KQ

5

and KQ 5(p-DP)

mer

6e

T0

508 the same value at low pH, we can conclude that the enzyme is converted both by FDP and by H + -ions into states which a r e identical with respect to the binding of PEP. One may argue that it is not allowed to interpret n H in such a molecular way. However, the same conclusions a r e obtained if the analysis of the pHdependence of n^ is based on the intrinsic parameters determining the "interaction coefficient" in t e r m s of the model of Monod, Wyman and Changeux. If these conclusions a r e valid, there must exist a strong correlation between the effects of FDP and H + -ions. In Fig. 4 negative logarithms of FDP concentrations (p(FDP)') which cause a certain n^-value are plotted versus those pH-values which cause the same n^. The straight line obtained in fact indicates a 1:1correlation between the allosteric effects of FDP and H + -ions. After those groups which a r e essential for enzyme activity are characterized by their dissociation constants» we a r e now trying to identify the corresponding aminoacid residues by chemical modifications. At the moment we can present only some preliminary results of our studies on the function of thiol groups. Yeast pyruvate kinase contains five cysteine residues per subunit, all being in the reduced thiol form. In the absence of denaturing agents only three of them can be substituted by Ellman's reagent, and this substitution leads to a total loss of activity. However, one SH-group exerts an appreciable higher reactivity towards ELLMAN's reagent, iodoacetate or iodoacetamide than the other two. Thus, by reaction with iodoacetamide a substituted enzyme (CAM-PK) was prepared which contains 0. 8 to 1. 0 carboxamidomethylated thiolgroups per subunit. Although it is not exactly proved now, it can be assumed that this highly reactive SH-group is substituted above all. Fig. 5 presents the saturation curves of the native and the carboxamidomethylated enzyme obtained in the absence and presence of FDP. As the greatest alteration of the kinetic parameters is only about 15 %, we can colclude that the highly reactive SH-group is not involveld in enzyme activity. With ELLMAN's reagent more than one SH-group react. If one plots the fractional inhibition (i) versus the number of substituted SH-groups per subunit (Fig. 6), it can be seen that there is no loss of activity if less than 0. 8 to 1.0 SH-groups have reacted and that inactivation is complete if 2. 5 SH-groups are substituted. These results demonstrate that one SH-group is situated in or near the active site of yeast pyruvate kinase, and we conclude that the pf^-value of 8.4 to 9. 0 corresponds to this SH-group.

509 n

H 3.0-

no FOP

/ ¡.35—*j

2.0-

/

• •

1.0

-i

1 A

1

1 6

1

5 mM FOP 1 8

r-

10 pH

Fig. 1. pH-dependence of the "interaction coefficient" n„ in the absence and presence of fructose -1, 6-diphosphate (FDP).

5 mM FDP

PK0.5

4.0-

3.0-

no FDP

PH 2.0

10

Fig. 2. pH-dependence of the "half saturation constant" Kg g in the absence and presence of fructose -1,6-diphosphate (FDP).

510

Fig. 3. pH-dependence of the "maximal velocity" V m a x in the absence and presence of fructose -1, 6- diphosphate (FDP).

8

0 . 01

CH3 HOCH2CH2O

-

-

CH3O

-

-

0

y

R - P - 0 Ç H

2

J ]

OH

OH OH (19) a R = OH

d R-

b R = H

e R - CH 3

H0CH 2 CH 2

c R = H0CH 2

f a -

H0CH 2 CH 2 0

564 the phosphorus atom is necessary to accomplish the binding. The requirement of the hydrophilic nature of the region surrounding the active site in this enzyme also follows from its specificity for derivatives with 3' -hydroxylic group in a ribo configuration. In this review, only some typical effects of nucleotide modification have been summarized, without mentioning the great variaty of special cases. On the basis of the understanding of substrate requirements of the enzymes of nucleic acid metabolism, a synthesis of specific inhibitors can be expected in near future. Thus, the theoretical value of our present temptations can turn in a broad applicability in molecular biology.

REFERENCES (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6)

HOLY, A., F. SORM, Collection Czechoslov. Chem. Commun. 34, (1969), 3383 HOLY, A., F. SORM, Collection Czechoslov. Chem. Commun., in press HOLY, A., Tetrahedron Letters (1971), 189 HOLY, A., unpublished results GASSEN, H.G., H. WITZEL, European J. Biochem. 1, (1967), 36 HOLY, A., R.W. BALD, Collection Czechoslov. Chem. Commun., ' in p r e s s

(7)

HOLY, A., R.W. BALD, F. SORM, Collection Czechoslov. Chem. Commun. in p r e s s (8) PONGS, O., Dissertation. Marburg 1969 (9) HOLY, A., Collection Czechoslov. Chem. Commun. 33, (1968), 2245 (10) HOLY, A., Collection Czechoslov. Chem. Commun., in p r e s s (11) HOLY, A., Collection Czechoslov. Chem. Commun. 35, (1970), 81 (12) HOLY, A., F. SORM, Biochim. Biophys. Acta 161, (1968), 264 (13) HOLY, A., F. SORM, Collection Czechoslov. Chem. Commun. 34, (1969), 3523 (14)

HOLY, A., F. EGAMI, in preparation

(15)

HOLY, A., Collection Czechoslov. Chem. Commun. 34, (1969), 3510

(16)

HOLY, A., Tetrahedron Letters (1967), 881

(17)

YENGOYAN, L . , D. H. RAMMLER, Biochem. 5, (1966), 3629

(18)

JONES, G.H., J.G. MOFFATT, J. Am. Chem. Soc. 90, (1968), 5337

(19)

JONES, G. H., H. P.Soc. ALBRECHT, P. DAMODARAN, J. G. MOFFATT, J. Am. Chem. 92, (1970),N.5510

565 (20)

ECKSTEIN, F . , Tetrahedron Letters (1967), 1157

(21)

ECKSTEIN, F . , J . Am. Chem. Soc. 92, (1970), 4718

(22)

ECKSTEIN, F . , H. GINDL, European J . Biochem.

(23)

KUCERQVA, Z . , J . SKODA, A. HOLY, F. SORM, Collection Czechoslovak

(24)

HOLY, A . , Collection Czechoslov. Chem. Commun. 32, (1967), 3713

(25)

HOLY, A . , N. D. HONG, Collection Czechoslov. Chem. Commun. 36, (1967), 3713

(26)

HOLY, A . , N. D. HONG, in preparation

(1970), 558

Chem. Commun. 33, (1968), 4350

Biochemisches Institut der Universität Münster

H. WITZEL CATALYTIC PRINCIPLES USED IN THE REACTIONS OF RNase A, T . 1 AND T 2 WITH SUBSTRATES

Studies on enzyme mechanisms should demonstrate how enzymes lower the activation energy for a definite reaction. We studied this problem on a relatively simple reaction - the hydrolysis of the 3' -5' -phosphodiester bond of ribonucleic acids, which is catalysed by different ribonucleases. Our results permit us now to compare the prinziples used by the pancreatic RNase A, by the RNase T^ and the RNase Tg, both isolated from aspergillus orycae (1). The overall reaction from the 3' -diester (I) to the 3' -monoester (IE) passes a 2 ' , 3' -cyclic diester (n), an intermediate which can be isolated.

0 OH 1 "O-P-O I OH RNase A : B, •= C,U RNase T-,: =• 6 RNase T 2 :BI= A,G,C,U

This indicates that all three enzymes catalyse in a first step a transesterification in which a 2' 0 - P bond i s formed while the 5' 0 - P bond is split. In a second step the just formed 2' 0-P bond is split again, while a water molecule enters the phosphate group. The result is a 3' -monoester. Instead of a water molecule an alcohol molecule can react with II yielding a new 3' -diester. In presence of high concentrations of nucleosides the original 3 ' . 5' -diesters can be obtained.

568

It should be justified to assume the same mechanism and the same type of activation for HOH and HOR, when both react as nucleophiles. Therefore we can conclude that the second step i s exactly the reverse of the first step and that analogous transitition states are passed in both steps. The three enzymes, however, differ in their specificity. RNase A splits only, when B j i s a pyrimidine base, the T^ enzyme requires a guanine base and the Tg enzyme splits all internucleotide bonds. This indicates that the catalytic process i s complex and contains elements in the activation energy A E which depend on a specific function of the base, or better said, the base has functions which contribute to the lowering of the overall A E. Without any catalysis at pH 7 the process should follow an

type mechanism

for both steps. The "in line" variant (IVa, b) is expected to need a higher activation energy than the "adjacent" variant (Va, b).

Base catalysis at the 2' -OH group or at the water molecule should follow the same mechanisms (IV or V). Here again the "adjacent" mechanism should be preferred, since the base taking up the proton can immediately transfer the proton to the leaving group. Thus complete separation of charges and conversion of configuration are not required. The problem i s not yet decided (2). The "in line" mechanism, on the other hand, requires two different bases for the two reaction, steps while the "adjacent" variant requires only one base.

569 Proton catalysis leads to an addition mechanism with the formalition of a proton stabilized intermediate state with pentacovalent phosphorus (Via, b). The reaction follows exactly second order with the proton concentration indicating that only the simultaneous attack of two protons leads to the formation of the pentacovalent intermediate. The breakdown of the intermediate needs an additional catalysis by protons which might act at the 2' -o (back reaction) or at the 3' -0 (formation of a 2' -5' -diester) or at the 5' -0 (formation of the 2 ' , 3' -cyclic product). Here also an "in line" or an "adjacent" mechanism can be discussed, the latter connected with the problem of pseudorotation which is a relatively fast process and therefore does not influence the rate (3). We see that proton catalysis acts in two ways. Protonation at the free oxygens leads to an increase of electrophilicity at the phosphorus and facilitates the attack of the nucleophil, while protonation of the ester oxygens leads to a polarisation of the bond and lowers the activation energy to cleave it. This additional proton catalysis therefore is responsible for a selective cleavage among equivalent bonds. The enzymes have to use the same priciples. In addition, they can also lower the overall activation energy by the entropy term which can be completely neglected in the nonenzymatic catalysis. Theoretically, there is no reason, why they should not use base and proton catalysis simultaneously, together with a further decrease of the activation energy by an increase in the probability factor, therefore, we expect that the catalytic process in our enzyme reactions might use completely different contributions and combinations to lower the activation energy. This is roughly indicated by the different base specificity. We discuss first our results on RNase A: It could be demonstrated that there exists no evidence that the nucleophilic site, i. e. the 2' -OH group or the water molecule can be activated by the enzyme (4). The only argument to support such a concept might be derived from the bell shaped pH-dependence curve of the kinetic parameters K m and kg (5). But other concepts are in agreement with bell shaped curves a s well (6). On the other hand, we found that all substrates need the C-2 oxygen of the pyrimidine base which we had shown some years ago to accelerate the rate in the nonenzymatic hydrolysis, too (7). Even the simple 2-oxo-pyridone nucleotide (VII) or pyridazine nucleotide (Vm) diesters are substrates, demonstrating that the position 3, 4, 5 and 6 of the

570

pyrimidine base does not play a specific role in the catalytic process. Many other compounds confirm this result.

NH

c> - ^ ¡ " > ^ 4 •oy L Ov^/O

i 0

HO

Xmi/IH

TYYTir

i /«-OH "0

0

/

o

K m is a function of k + g. This again indicates that the catalytic site contributes to the binding strength. We see again that K m is higher that means the binding is weaker in the second step when a water molecule is the nucleophile. The third fixation of the substrate occurs obviously by the interaction of the phosphate group with an imidazolium ion, indicated by the increase of K m at pH 7, when k + g drops down. Both enzymes follow obviously the same type of

X \

I

0—H-B-i /E\ + His • 0| • HBJ /\ rg+ ~0 0 p

catalysis in form of an S^2 type mechanism in the "adjacent" variant. The additional binding, at the base and at the phosphate group, plays here a major role. We see that hydrophobic interactions in T 2 and specific H-bonds of the base in T j can replace each other. At the catalytic site we find in both cases a B- HB system in which B^ is a carboxylate group, Bg however might be another carboxylate or an imidazol. They determine the different pH-dependence.

583 Comparing these two enzymes with the RNase A, we see that the base binding site is related to factor D. Instead of substrate binding performs the base in RNase A now a base and subsequent proton catalysis for the bond exchange according to an addition mechanism. Although the three enzymes catalyse the same bond exchange, it is clear from our present data, that they use a series of principles in different combinations to lower the activation energy. They can be interchanged. This facilitates the thinking of the construction of enzyme analogous catalysts considerably.

REFERENCES (1) (2)

EGAMI, F . , K. NAKAMURA, in Microbial Ribonucleases, Springer Verlag Berlin, Heidelberg, New York 1969 RICHARDS, F . M . , H.W. WYCKOFF, in The Enzymes, Ed. by BOYER, Academic Press, in press

(3)

USHER, D. A., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci., 62, (1969), 661

(4)

GASSEN, H.G., H. WITZEL, Europ. J. Biochem., 1, (1967), 36

(5)

HERRIES, D.G., A. P. MATHIAS, B.R. RABIN, Biochem. J . , 85, (1962), 127

(6)

WITZEL, H., Progress in Nucleic Acid Research, 2, (1963), 221

(7)

WITZEL, H., Ann. Chem., 635, (1960), 191

(8)

WIEKER, H. J . , H. WITZEL, Europ. J. Biochem., 1, (1967), 251

(9)

FOLLMANN, H., H.J. WIEKER, H. WITZEL, Europ. J. Biochem., 1, (1967), 243 (10) HUMMEL, J. P . , H. WITZEL, J. Biol. Chem., 241,, (1966), 1023 (11) BARNARD, E.A., H. WITZEL, unpublished, see ref. 12 (12) RUTERJANS, H. ,H. WITZEL, Europ. J. Biochem., 9, (1969), 118 (13) DEAVIN, A., A. P. MATHIAS, B.R. RABIN, Nature, 211, (1966), 252 (14) DEAVIN, A., R. C. FISHER, C. M. KEMP, A. P. MATHIAS, B.R. RABIN, Europ. J. Biochem., 7, (1968), 21 (15) WITZEL, H., unpublished results (16) HARRIS, M.R., D. A. Proc. USHER, H. P. ALBRECHT, G.H. JONES, J.G. D.W., MOFFATT, Natl. Acad Sci., 63, (1969), 246 (17) MILES. M.J. ROBINS, R. K. ROBINS, M.W. WINKLEY, H. EYRING, J. Am. Chem. Soc., 91, (1969), 824 (18) ' TS'O, P.O. P . , N.S. KONDO, M. P. SCHWEIZER, D. P. HOLLIS, Biochemistry, 8, (1969), 997

584 (19)

BALD, W . , Thesis, Marburg 1969

(20)

WITZEL, H., A. HOLY, Abstract 103, 6. F E B S meeting, Madrid 1969

(21)

WITZEL, H., W. BALD, A. HOLY, Abstract A96, 7. Symposium on the Chemistry of Natural Products, Riga 1970

(22)

IKEHARA, M . , K. MURAO, S. NISHIMURA, Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 182, (1969), 276

(23)

WARD, D. C . , W. FULLER, E. REICH, Proc. Natl. Acad. S c i . , 62, (1969), 581

(24)

WHITFELD, P . R . , H. WITZEL, Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 72, (1963), 338

(25)

PONGS, O . , Thesis, Marburg 1968

(26)

RUTERJANS, H. WITZEL, O. PONGS, Biochem. Biophys. Res. Comm., 37, (1969), 247

(27)

KAISER, P . , Diplomarbeit, Marburg 1971

Slovak Academy of Sciences, Biological Institute, Department of Biochemistry of Microorganisms, Bratislava

E. ZELINKOVA, M. BACOVA, J. ZELINKA THE SPECIFIC RIBONUCLEASE FROM STREPTOMYCES AUREOFACIENS

A ribonuclease from the cultural medium of Streptomyces aureofaciens, a chlortetracycline producing strain, was isolated and purificated. The purified enzyme was chromatographically and electrophoretically homogeneous and it was found to be free of deoxyribonuclease, non-specific phosphodiesterase and monoesterase activities. It was shown by the analysis of the products resulting from the action of Str. aureofaciens RNase on yeast transfer RNA that this enzyme, like the well studied ribonuclease T^, is an endonuclease splitting the ester bond between the guano sine 3' -phosphate and the -OH group at 5' -position of adjoining nucleotide under the formation of guanosine-2', 3' - cyclic phosphate a s an intermediate. This intermediate is then hydrolyzed by the enzyme to guanosine 3' -phosphate. Therefore Str. aureofaciens ribonuclease can be regarded a s a guanylic acid-specific endonuclease. The properties of Str. aureofaciens RNase a r é very similar to those of RNase T^ (1). This RNase is also an acidic protein, but it contains lower amounts of aspartic acid, tyrosine and serine. The content of basic amino acids lysine and arginine, is higher than in the RNase T^ (2, 3). The isoelectric point lies around pH 4, 3, while the RNase T^ has its isoelectric point around pH 2, 9 (3). The specificity of Str. aureofaciens RNase was demonstrated by the cleavage experiments of synthetic homopolynucleotides. Using 10 units of ribonuclease, poly A, poly C and poly U did not appear to be attacked even after 20 hour incubation the test samples remaining at the origin of the chromatogram s. Poly I was hydrolyzed at a higher rate than poly G. Using the ribonuclease in excess (approximately 3000 units) both poly A and poly U were hydrolyzed besides poly G and poly I. IRIE (4) reported also the splitting of poly A, poly C and poly U by ribonuclease T^. A similar phenomenon was observed with pyrimidine specific pancreatic RNase which hydrolyzed also poly (5, 6) and poly I (6) if used in excess.

586

Using dinucleosidemonophosphates as substrates, it was found, that only GpC, GpU, GpA and GpG were cleaved. The splitting of these substrates was measured spectrophotometrically by the change of optical density at appropriate wavelength in an automatic recording spectrophotometer with the constant temperature bath (37 ). Time course of the splitting of some dinucleosidemonophosphates is shown in Fig. 1. The relative rates of splitting of these substrates in comparison with those of RNase T j (Table 1) are not quite in agreement with results of WHITEFELD and WITZEL (7) for the RNase T , .

Table 1 RELATIVE RATES OF SPLITTING OF DIFFERENT DINUCLEOSIDEMONOPHOSPHATES BY RIBONUCLEASE FROM STR. AUREOFACIENS AND BY RIBONUCLEASE T,

(Experimental conditions are described in Fig. 1. )

The difference between splitting rates of various dinucleosidemonophosphates found with Str. aureofaciens RNase, RNase T^ (7) and RNase from Actinomyces aureoverticillatus (8), indicate that the reaction rate is influenced by the nucleoside bound to the 3' -guanylic acid. WITZEL and BARNARD (9) observed the influence of second nucleoside on the reaction rate also with pancreatic RNase. Kinetic parameters, K

and V

of Str. aureofaciens RNase with different

587 Table 2 KINETIC CONSTANTS OF RNase FROM STR. AUREOFACIENS USING DIFFERENT SUBSTRATES AT pH 7, 0 K m „ (x 10 M)

Vmax (mole/min/10000 U)

2,09

1,65. 10

GpC

2,44 « 1,428

1,33.10 0 2, 86. 10" 7

GpG GpA

1,176 0, 909

2, 00. 10" 7

GpU

0, 526

1,25. 10" 7 0, 59. 10" 7

G-cyclic-p (pH 7)

11,5

8,13. 10" 9

G-cyclic-p (pH 5, 7)

3,6

3,7. 10~9

Substrate

Commercial yeast RNA yeast high polymerized RNA

1)

Vmax of GpX r V of GpU max

-60 !>

4, 84 3, 39 2,12 1,0

in M of average nucleotide

(The reaction mixture contained in 1, 5 ml dinucleosidemonophosphates in the final concentrations 0, 5 - 2, 0.10~ 4 M in 0, 05 M phosphate buffer (pH 7, 0) and enzyme solution (25/il). G-cyclic -p (pH 7) - titration method: the reaction mixture contained 0,1M NaCl, 1 mM phosphate buffer (pH 7), 5 -15.10~ 3 M substrate and 25^x1 enzyme in 1, 6 ml. Titrant: 0, 02N NaOH. Incubation temperature: 37°C. G-cyclic-p (pH 5, 7) - electrophoretic assay: the reaction mixture (0,4 ml) contained 0,1M phosphate buffer (pH 5,7), 1, 8 - 28.10" 4 M substrate and RNase (25¿ul). Paper electrophoresis (filterpaper WHATMAN No 3): Electrophoresis was run at 18 V/cm for 1, 5 hour in 1/150 M phosphate buffer pH 7,4).

substrates are summarized in Table 2. For better comparison, all measurements were carried out at pH 7, 0 i. e. at the pH optimum for the splitting of the internucleotide bond (1). The KIII values a s well a s the V U l a X values are decreasing in the following order GpC > G p G > GpA > GpU. The same effect was observed byJ IRIE with RNase T, but only for the V values v(10). The K values a r e 1 ' max ' m higher than those of RNase T j . The magnitude of V m a x values in comparison with RNase T, is lower.

588 The kinetic parameters of hydrolysis of guanosine 2 ' , 3' -cyclic phosphate were determined at pH 7 by pH stat method and at pH optimum 5, 7 an electrophoretic assay was used. The finding that the lower K m values was obtained at pH 5, 7 rather than at pH 7 and that the VIII A X value was higher at neutral pH is in accordance with the results obtained by IRIE (11) for RNase T^, while its pH optimum for 2 ' , 3' cyclic GMP hydrolysis was found to be pH 7, 0.

LITERATURE (1)

ZELINKOVA, E., M. BACOVA, J. ZELINKA, Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 235, (1971), 343

(2)

BACOVA, M., E. ZELINKOVA, J. ZELINKA, Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 235, (1971), 335 TAKAHASHI, T . , J. Biochem. 51, (1962), 95 IRIE, M., J. Biochem. 58, (1965), 599 IMURA, N., M. IRIE, T. UKTTA, J. Biochem. 58, (1965), 264 BEERS, R . F . , J. Biol. Chem. 235, (1960), 2393 WHITFELD, P . R . , H. WITZEL, Biochim. Biophys. Acta 72, (1963), 338 ABROSIMOVA - AMELJANCHIK, N. M., R. I. TATARSKAYA, T. V. VENKSTERN, V. D. AKSELROD, A. A. BAEV, Biochimiya 30, (1965), 1269

(3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9)

WITZEL, H., E.A. BARNARD, Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 7, (1962), 295

(10)

IRIE, M. , J . Biochem. 63, (1968), 649

(11)

IRIE, M., J. Biochem. 61, (1967), 550

589

TIME (MINUTES) Fig. 1. Time course of the splitting of some dinucleosidemonophosphate by Str. aureofaciens RNase. (Reaction mixture (1, 5 ml) contained 0, 05 M phosphate buffer pH 7, 0 0, 2 m U substrate and 13000 units of RNase).

Institute of Biochemistry and Physiology of Microorganisms; Academy of Sciences of the USSR, Puschino on the Oka, Moscow Region, USSR

S.I. BEZBORODOVA SOME PROPERTIES OF EXTRACELLULAR RNases OF FUNGI

EGAMI and NAKAMURA in the monograph "Microbial Ribonucleases" (1969) concluded that molecular weight of base specific RNases is 11000-13000 and that of nonspecific ones 30000-40000 with the exception of RNase of Bac. subtilis Marburg. Our investigations on extracellular RNases of Fungi revealed that fungi were able to synthesize and secrete nonspecific RNases, different in molecular weight and optimum pH, into the culture medium. RNases with molecular weight of about 11000 have optimum pH in weak alkali (Asp. clavatus, Asp. pallidus, P. chrysogenum 152A, F. semitectum) and RNases with molecular weight of 30000-40000 have optimum pH 4 to 6. RNases were isolated from the filtrate of the culture fluid and purified to the chromatography homogeneous state. The steps of the purification were a s follows: 1. Ammonium sulfate precipitation or fractionation with acetone. 2. DEAE- and CM-cellulose column chromatography. 3. Gel-chromatography on the Sephadexes G-100 and G-75. RNases were purified about 500-2500 times with the yield from 2 to 60 %. Homogeneity was studied with disc electrophoresis in polyacrylamide gel under different pH (Fig. 1) and ultracentrifugation. Figures 2a and b show UV spectra of some RNases. Some RNases were obtained in the amount to 10 mg and more with the result that their amino acid composition was determined. The presence of histidine was ascertained in all the RNases under investigation. There is some analogy in general amino acid composition of "alkali" RNases and that of RNase T j Asp. oryzae. For this reason we consider the investigations on the relation between the structure and the function of this group of RNases to be very interesting for the establishing of the cause of base specificity. Some properties of RNases studied are given in Table 1 and 2. Aotivity of enzymes depending on pH is expressed in the bellshape curve (Fig. 3). It may by proposed

592

-J

O

' S * " S «

M TH

CM i-H

O

o Tj"

CM 1-1

O

CM iH O iH

T

©

T o

o co

o »-t

o co

S "

o

.c— . to

So

So

« A

c-

c i

co

r-

S

a

» &« a

o m

o in

•>©

ir • iH -4-J O « !

cu

If t«

co

i W Ei

«

o.

• g »

i

i

xi

f

ft-w

H co CQ

« a

» a

CM

co

o CD

o co

co co

m m

m cm

o m

in co

oo

t-'eo"

a, o

O

in

(U ta

d

^

o

d

« « CM

S

i

i

r- «1 A 1 P4-4->

co

I tó of 3

i

CQ cg 5

ci

>. tn A U

e

a> ft

S

S >• § (H

u g

ft

o

c-"oo"

ai (0

O co W I

H

1

in

u

« ÍH

ft

in" co"

Ï &-

ta

$

O

co

t-"c-"

A

Z

H §

CM 0 0

1

Iii"

a>

en H m

ao"

t-

K

u

V a m



p

ü
O Cli •al u30 g" §o

^

a A o o o Ol

a A o co *H IO

a A g. o «o i-H iH

o

O A P A

O A P A u A

O A o T? C > I > A > U (on C ^ p a s a substrate).

595 Cytidine-5' -di- and 5' -triphosphates inhibited RNase P. brevicompactum stronger than cytidine-5' -monophosphate did (Fig. 6). Among four common ribonucleosides, the inhibitory effect was in the following order: A ^ G> C ^ U (Fig. 7), but that of the RNase M was A=- C^G=-U. The present report is a brief account of investigation carried out by the author in collaboration with I. V. ILYINA, V. G. MOROSOVA, V.I. KRUPIANKD, V.M. GRISTCHENKD, L.I. BORODAEVA, R.B. MARKAUSKAJTE, N.J. MARKELOVA, Z.N. BAGDASARJAN.

596

Fig. 1. Disc electrophoresis of RNases. a) at pH 8, 3 1 - RNase P. claviforme 2 - RNase P.brevicompactum. b) at pH 3, 0 1 - RNase P. claviforme 2 - RNase P. brevicompactum.

m(i—

Fig. 2. UV spectra of RNases. a) alcaline RNases 1. Cg Asp. clavatus 2. P. chrysogenum 152 A b) acidic RNases 1. p. claviforme 2. P.brevicompactum.

597

Fig. 3. Effect of pH on the activity of RNases. a) Substate - RNA 1. acidic RNase P. claviforme 2. alcaline RNase P. chrysogenum 152 A b) Substrate - U > p , acidic RNase P. chrysogenum 152 A.

598

Fig. 4. Gel-chromatography on the Sephadex G-100 of products of degradation RNA by RNase F. semitectum. 1 - RNA 2 - 30-min. hydrolysate 3 - 24 -hr. hydrolysate 4 - AMP

Fig. 5. Competitive inhibition of RNase P. brevicompactum by cytidine nucleotides.

599

0

7

2

3

4

5 7/S

Fig. 7. The inhibition of RNase P. brevicompactum by various nucleosides.

5.

SPECIAL TO PIE S

Biochemisches Institut der Universität Freiburg im Breisgau and Gesellschaft für Strahlen- und Umweltforschung München

R. WOHLHUETER, H. HOLZER THERMODYNAMICS OF THE ADENYLYLATION OF GLUTAMINE SYNTHETASE

In a previous paper Prof. Holzer has discussed the regulatory significance of the adenylylation of glutamine synthetase in E. coli. Attempts to define the regulatory event as fully as possible have unearthed a number of interesting features of the enzymology and chemistry of adenylyl transfer. In this paper we want to emphasize some aspects of the reaction novel to biological chemistry, in particular the generation of a new kind of "high-energy phosphate bond". At the same time we will point out some of the problems we have encountered, how we have coped with them, and how such problems are of general relevance to the study of nucleotidyl transfer reactions. Nucleotidyl group transfer is well established in the repertoire of enzymatic reactions. In Table 1 we have listed some example and have classified them into

Table 1 Reaction Type

Examples

ATP + R-O-P »e® A-P-P-R + PPj

ATP: nicotinamide mononucleotide adenylyltransferase

NTP + glycosyl-P NDP-glycoside + PP i NTP + 3' -OH-NA w*NA n+1. + PP.i

ATP: panthetheine-4' phosphate adenylyltransferase UTP: oc -D-glucose-1phosphate uridylyl transferase ONA Polymerase

Equilibrium Reference = 0.45 (yeast, 3mM Mg) reversible

(1)

K =0.3 eq

(3) (4)

reversible

(5)

Keq

(2)

604 three categories, based on the type of acceptor. The first type occurs in the synthesis of the coenzyme dinucleotides, in which the acceptor is phosphate esterified with a primary alcohol. Reactions of this type have proven to be readily reversible. A second sort of nucleotidyl transfer is that found in the synthesis of the various nucleotide-diphosphate sugars, where the acceptor is a glycosyl1-phosphate. These reactions, too, involve little free-energy change. A very important category is the nucleic acid polymerases. In contrast to our first two categories, the acceptor here is the bare 3' -hydroxyl of the (deoxy)ribosyl group. Although this reaction too has been shown to be reversible in the presence of high pyrophosphate concentrations (5), one must recognize that the free-energy of the products includes some 7. 5 kcal due to base-pairing of the newly added nucleotide with its template, and that this hydrogen-bond energy is presumably available to drive the reverse reaction. The transfer of the adenylyl group from ATP to glutamine synthetase fits none of these prototypes and thus represents a new category of biological nucleotidyl group transfer:

IIIH

CH-CH 2 HA)>— OH + MgATP2- | AG°' C=0 I \ NH KIH 0

1.3 kcal

CH-CH 2 -«(^>-0-P-0-adenosine + MgPP2"+ H+

r

C=0 I

0_

Here the acceptor group is the phenolic hydroxyl of a tyrosyl residue in the glutamine synthetase peptide chain (6); the products are a protein-bound phosphodiester and inorganic pyrophosphate (7); the reaction is reversible (8). Furthermore, in the present paper we will present evidence a) that the magnesium complexes of ATP and pyrophosphate are the actual reactants, b) that the glutamine synthetase subunit reacts independently of the state of adenylylation of its neighbors, and c) that the reaction is only slightly exothermic. The first Droblem that confronts one who wishes to determine the thermodynamic parameters of such a reaction is the multiplicity of ionic forms in which ATP and pyrophosphate exist in neutral solutions containing magnesium. Pyrophosphate,

605 in addition to its various protonation levels, forms single and double complexes with magnesium. ATP, of course, also exists as MgATP complex, and when both ATP and pyrophosphate are present in solution simultaneously they compete for available magnesium ions. Dissociation constants for the various individual metal-ligand pairs are available from the literature (9), and the combination of these equations with the conservation equations for total magnesium, pyrophosphate, and ATP permits calculation of the composition of a mixture of all the various ionic forms in equilibrium with one another. The solution of such a system of equations is arduous, so we have enlisted a computer's aid to make the calculations (10). The results obtained by such calculations are illustrated in Fig. 1. The upper part shows how the distribution of the major forms of ATP change as a function of total magnesium concentration in a solution containing 1 mM total ATP at pH 7.4. At low magnesium concentrations the changes are very steep, but above 5 mM magnesium the change becomes slight, since ATP is present nearly completely as MgATP. The more complicated picture with, pyrophosphate is shown in part B, for pH 7.4 and 1 mM total pyrophosphate. The relative o 2 proportions of MgPP and MggPP vary over a wide range of magnesium concentrations, and it may be appreciated, for instance, that, if the actual product of a reaction is a specific ionic form of pyrophosphate, an equilibrium constant calculated using the total concentration of pyrophosphate, will be a) an overestimate, and b) dependent upon the magnesium concentration. How these considerations work in practice we will show below, but first we should describe how we measure equilibrium of the reaction. Glutamine synthetase is composed of 12 identical subunits, each of which may be adenylylated. Thus, on a population average at least, there may be from 0 to 12 moles of AMP incorporated per mole of enzyme. Reaction mixtures containing pure glutamine synthetase, pure adenylyltransferase and various ratios of pyrophosphate to ATP are allowed to attain equilibrium. The ratio of adenylylated to non-adenylylated enzyme subunits are computed from linear extrapolation between the two extremes of fully adenylylated and non-adenylylated enzyme. Pyrophosphate and ATP are used in sufficiently high concentration (compared to glutamine synthetase) so that their concentrations at equilibrium do not differ appreciably from their initial concentrations. An example of the sort of results obtained is given in Table 2. Although there is some disagreement over the matter of linearity (11), this and many similar sets of data give us reasonable

606 confidence in the aptness of our assumption of the linear relationship between activity and adenylylation, since the constants thus calculated a r e indeed constant. They suggest one further important conclusion, namely that each subunit of glutamine synthetase behaves a s a thermodynamically independent entity. We see that with each concentration term at unit exponent there is equivalence among the constants found at various pyrophosphate/ATP ratios. If cooperative effects existed in the adenylylation of the subunits, one would expect that the expression for the equilibrium constant would involve exponents greater than one, in which case the essential property of equivalence would be lost. L e t ' s return now to the question of the distribution of pyrophosphate ions and its influence upon equilibrium calculations. We will consider two possible expressions for an apparent equilibrium, one based on the total concentrations of pyrophosphate and ATP (Kp), the other on the concentrations of the magnesium complexes (K^^):

Table 2 Reaction


total

Adenylylation Ratio

K » eq

(mM)

(mM)

a

2.0

0.15

0.883

11.8

b

2.0

0. 30

1. 81

c

1.0

0.15

d e

1.0 1.0

0. 30

2.21 4.15

12.1 14.8

0.45

5. 35

13.8 11.9 12. 9 + 0. 6

average + standard error (subunit-AMP) (PP) (subunit)

(ATP).

The reaction mixtures contained 0.1 M imidazole/HCl buffer, pH 7. 0, 20 mM L-glutamine, 10 mM MgSO^, 130/ig glutamine synthetase, 35(tig adenylyltransferase, and ATP and pyrophosphate a s noted in a total volume of 200 ¿il. Activity

607 corresponding to completely adenylylated enzyme is that found when (PPj) = O and (ATP) = 1 mM. Activity was measured in a similar reaction where pyrophosphate and ATP were replaced by 10 Vizard (Agama sang.) white mouse 1

Fig. 1. Temperature optimum of creatine kinase reaction.

616

Fig. 2. Correlation of creatine kinase activities at two temperatures (enzyme from the tissues of Rana temporaria developing tadpoles).

I tail

H head

days of development Fig. 3. Creatine kinase isoenzyme variations in the tissues of Rana temporaria developing tadpoles.

Bach Institute of Biochemistry USSR Academy of Sciences, Moscow

K.B. SEREBROVSKAYA THE BEHAVIOR OF TRANSFERASES IN HETEROGENIC LIPID -WAT ER SYSTEMS

In early 1930-ies A. I. OPARIN and his coworkers published in the "Biochemische Zeitschrift" several papers concerning inactivation of a number of enzymes during their adsorption on colloidal precipitates. The enzymes could be reactivated through their desorption by other proteins (1). At that time (2) it was already known that the protoplasm i s a gel-like structure. On the basis of their experiments with regards to a reversible inactivation of enzymes A. I. OPARIN and his followers developed a hypothesis on the mechanism of reversible desorption in the regulation of enzyme activity in a living cell (3). They believed that cellular lipids played an important role in the process. Today these concepts are evidely develop by P. SIEKEWITZ and coworkers (4). The second importand stage in the study of this problem was the work of D. L. TALMUD and his collaborators in early 1940-ies. The investigated the role of hydrophobic forces in the protein - protein and protein-lipid interactions (5). Their ideas are widely used in up-to-day studies of protein conformation transitions (6). The third stage in the study of the problem was the investigations carried out in this country in 1950-ies with respect to a reversible action of enzymes in a living cell. It has been shown both by Soviet biochemists and scholars abroad that invertase appears to be transferase capable to transfer p -fructosyl of sucrose to different acceptors (water, alcohols and other sugars) (7). The reaction develops according to MYRBACK's scheme: E + S ===== ES

E - P2 + Pi — • P2 + t

This scheme has been confirmed by JOUNG (8) and is applicable, in his opinion, to most transferases. Bearing in mind the above concepts we investigated activity of transferases

618 (rlbonuclease, hexokinase and ATPase of myosin, in model lipid-water systems. The lecithin fraction produced from the brain tissue of cattle or from the egg yolk served as lipid. The lipid-water system was prepared according to the BUNGENBERG, de JONG method (9) used in the production of lipid coacervates and examined with the JEM-7A J. KUCHARA (Wrozlav Institute of Agricultural Research) and W. I. STEIN-MARGOLINA (Bach Institute of Biochemistry Moskow) (10).

Fig. 1, represents structures of the lipid-water system multiplied by 300. 000 times. These structures prepared by condensing the molecular-dispersed lipid (9) a r e completely identical to BENGHAM's liposomes (2) prepared through dispergation of condensed lipids. Fig. 2, shows serum albumin treated liposomes wich a r e entirely identical to liposomes obtained with the aid of subtilisin treatment. The liposome-protein interaction according to Bengham's terminology, results in protein-lipid penetration. It seems probable that the penetration is followed by a chemical protein-lipid interaction. Fig. 3 presents data on the influence of liposomes upon RNase activity (12) Curves 1, 2, 3,4 represent control measurements enzyme activity in a homogeneous -3 solution a s a function of time (the enzyme concentration varied from 2. 5.10" mg/ml to 2.10" 2 mg/ml). Curves 5,6, 7, 8 indicate measurements of enzyme activity in the presence of liposomes prepared from lecithin stored at -78°. As seem from the data, a decrease of the enzyme concentration in the reation mixture brings about a gradual inhibition of its hydrolytic activity of the enzyme occurs its. The presence of liposomes in the mixture results in the development of a synthetic process whose rate is the greater, the less the concentration of the enzyme. By assaying the iodine number, it was shown in parallel experiments that lecithin can be dehydrated in the cold, on the other hand, a study of extra-weak luminescence in lipid-wat'er systems indicated that the lipid-water interaction results ii) the disappearance of lipid peroxides wich are always present in an initial lecithin preparation. These date a comparison of the effect of liposomes produced from different age lecithin preparations on the RNase activity (13). -3 Fig. 4 shows the date obtained with two enzyme concentrations of 2. 5.10 and -2

2.10

mg/ml, the substrate concentration being the same (curves 1 and 2).

Curves 3 and 4 represent the enzyme activity in the presence of liposomes

619 prepared from two weaks old lecithin and curves 5 and 6 - in the presence of liposomes from three months old lecithin. These data demonstrate that at high enzyme concentrations "young" liposomes inhibit its but slightly. A decrease of the enzyme concentration induces synthetic, a activity during the first minutes of incubation which seems to be the ligher the "older" are the liposomes. In the course of incubation with the substrate the hydrolytic activity of the enzyme re-appears. Simular date were obtained in regard to the effect of liposomes on activity of ATPase of myosin (14,15,16) and yeast hexokinase (17,18). In these experiments exclusively a fresh lecithin fraction of brain was used for the preparation of liposomes and the influence of the lipid-water system of different age upon enzyme activity was studied. It was established that one-day liposomes greatly increase the rate of the direct reaction (Fig. 5, a and b, curves 2), whereas 3-5 day liposomes reverse the action of the tested enzymes (curves 3). The difference of action of "young" and "aged" liposomes may be ascribed to variations in their donor-acceptor capacity: "young" liposomes may act as proton donors while the "aged" - as acceptors. To verify this assumption specific experiments with respect to the influence of "aged" liposomes on the photooxidation of myosin ATP-ase in the presence of chlorophyll were carried out (19). As known sensitized oxidation of myosin results in an increased viscosity of its solution due to polymerization of the protein oxidized molecules. In our experiments an introduction of liposomes sharply increased the rate of the polymerization (Fig. 6). This may favour the idea that the lipid acts as a catalyst in this reaction. The process may be represented by the followed scheme:

hv

polymerization

620 According to SHERAGA (20) the mechanism of protein polymerization of the myosin type involves an internal redox reaction with the participation of histidine and tyrosine. In a monomolecular protein these sites are closed intramolecularly. Polymerization follows the disruption of intramolecular bonds and the formation of intermolecular ones, i. e. in status nascendi. In our opinion, it is the redox mechanism wich underlies the reversal of the transferase reaction. If it is assumed (21) that the dimer is an active form of RNase in the hydrolysis reaction and that the monomer is responsible for its synthetic activity, then the lipid may be regarded as a substance wich shifts the dimer ** monomer equilibrium towards monomerization of the enzyme by removing a proton from the active center, (e. g. from histidine). A study of the relationships between the specific synthetic activity and the concentration of the enzyme carried out in accordance with the method suggested by KURGANOV (22) has shown that in the lipid presence the activity increases along with a decline of the concentration. These events testify in favour of the monomer synthetic activity. In the case of hexokinase and ATPase "young" liposomes may also serve as proton donors, accelerating the rate of the direct reaction, whereas "aged" ones act as proton acceptors, contributing to the rate of the back reaction as with RNase (possibly at the expense monomerization on the lipid structure). According to SOLS (23)both enzymes work in this event as the some synthetic ATPase . It should be noted that a subunit ot yeast hexokinase with a molecular weight of 27. 5000 is fully identical to that of mitochondrial ATPase (6). The presence of substance in the reaction mixture which may act a s group acceptors in the transferase reaction may be regarded a s a second indispensable condition for a reversal. In the case of RNase the product of the reaction first stage (cyclophosphate) may be transferred to acid-soluble oligonucleotides making them acid-nonsoluble. In the experiments with the reversal of ATPase hexokinase action a decrease of'mineral phosphate in the first case and an increase of labile phosphate in the second one may be explained by the transfer of phosphorous of the phosphorylated enzyme to the medium ADP in the lipid presence. This transfer may take place only in status nascendi, i. e. during the disruption of phosphorous - enzyme bonds. In conclusion I wish to express my deep feelings of gratitude to my teacher Academician A. I. OPARINfor his constant interest advice and valuable remarks.

Fig. 1. P h o s p h a t i d e - w a t e r system liposomes X 300000.

621 REFERENCES (1)

OPARIN, A. I . , A. I. KURSANOV, Biochem. Z. 239, (1931), 1

(2)

LOEB, J . , The Dynamics of living m a t t e r

(3)

OPARIN, A . I . , Isw. AN USSR, Biol. Ser. 6, (1937)

(4)

SIKEVITS, P . , In "The molecular control of cellular activity", N. Y. McGrow -Hill Book Co. 1962

(5)

TALMUD, D . L . , Journ. phys. chem. (USSR) 15, (1941), 532

(6)

KLOTZ, J. M . . N.R. LANGERMAN, D.W. DARNALL, Annual Rev. Biochem., 39, (1970), 25

(7)

OPARIN, A. I . , La nature et le mechanisme d' action de 1' invertase de la levure. Communications et rapports au m Congres International de Biochemie Bruxelles, 1-6 août 1955

(8)

YOUNG, J u i . H . , Ann. Rev. Biochem. 38, (1969), 913

(9)

BUNGENBERG de JONG, H . I . , R. F. WASTERKAMP, Biochem. Z. 234, (1931), 347

(10)

SEREBROVSKAYA, K B . , Ja. KUCHARA, W. J . STEIN-MARGOLINA, Dokl. AN USSR (in press)

(11)

RACKER, E . , Membranes of mitochondria and chloroplasts 1970

(12)

OPARIN, A. I . , K B . SEREBROVSKAYA, N.W. VASILIEVA, W. M. SAMSONOVA, Dokl. AN USSR 179, (1968), 976

(13)

SEREBROVSKAYA, K B . , Coacervates and protoplasm, Nauka, 1971

(14)

SEREBROVSKAYA, K B . , W. M. SAMSONOVA, N. S. MENAJEDIBOVA, Dokl. AN USSR 180, (1968), 1250

(15)

SEREBROVSKAYA, K B . , T.O. BALAEVSKAYA, T . I . OSIPOVA, Dokl. AN USSR 187, (1969), 939

(16)

OPARIN, A. I . , K B . SEREBROVSKAYA, Dokl. AN USSR 185, (1969), 707

(17)

OPSTIN, A. I . , K B. SEREBROVSKAYA, L. S. GOGILASCHWILI, Dokl. AN USSR, 185, (1969), 952

(18)

SEREBROVSKAYA, K B . , L. S. GOGILASCHVILI, L. J . ANDRIADZE, Journ. evol. biochem. and physiol. (USSR), 5, (1969), 583

(19)

SEREBROVSKAYA, K B . , T. K LUZIK, T . I . OSIPOVA, Biochimia, USSR (in press)

(20)

SHERAGA, H. A . , In: The Proteins, vol. 1, H. Neurath (Ed.) N. Y. -London, 1963

(21)

SCHAPOT, V. S., Nucleases. M. Medicina, 1968

(22)

KURGANOV, B . I . , Mol.biol. (USSR), 2, (1968), 430

(23)

DELAFUENTE, G., In: FEBS Symposium 19, (1969), 249

wy

LV\\

//

Fig. 3. Effect of liposomes on the ribonuclease activity by the different enzyme concentration. 1,2, 3,4 - in the absence of liposomes 5,6,7, 8 - in the presence of liposomes.

y

Fig. 4. Effect of liposomes on the ribonuclease activity by the different enzyme concentration. 1,2 - in the absence of liposomes 3,4 - in the presence of "young" liposomes 5,6 - in the presence of "old" liposomes.

623 AEffO

M9f\

Fig. 5. Effect of liposomes on the ATPase and hexokinase activity, a - ATPase, b - hexokinase 1 - in the absence of liposomes 2 - in the presence of "young" liposomes 3 - in the presence of "old" liposomes.

624

A 7!

relative

Fig. 6. Effect of "old" liposomes on the polymerization rate of the myosin ATPase in the light - dark change. 1 - in the absence of liposomes „ 2 - in the presence of liposomes (8.10" mg/ml lecithin) 3 - in the presence of liposomes (22.10" 3 mg/ml).

Forschungszentrum für Molekularbiologie und Medizin der Deutschen Akademie der Wissenschaften zu Berlin, Berlin-Buch

J. G. REICH, G. WANGERMANN, MARGRIT FALCK A GENERAL COMPUTER STRATEGY FOR THE ANALYSIS OF KINETIC AND BINDING CURVES

The kinetic analysis of an enzyme is usually the first step of a more detailed investigation either of its molecular mechanism or of its importance within a metabolic network. A series of experiments is carried out with varied ligand concentrations and a suitably recorded output vector, such a s binding values or initial velocities. These data are then explored by graphical analysis, a system of plots and secondary plots, which serves to establish the numerical values of the kinetic parameters in question, and to discriminate among rival mechanisms. But this graphical analysis becomes very tedious and often rather unsystematic, when more complicated mechanisms, in particular allosteric models, a r e to be considered (1). We have therefore made an attempt to develop a general strategy of parameter estimation from initial velocity or binding data which could allow for a more systematic approach to the problem of kinetic analysis of enzyme mechanisms. The kinetic model in its most general form is y

k

=

f

(P'V

where P

= (Pj>P2'P3* • -P n )

(set of kinetic constants)

X^ = (ligj, ligg. • • lig d )

(ligand concentrations)

k

(number of experiments).

= 1 (1) m

y = ( y r Y2" • • y m ) is the fit to the experimental data v = (v^, Vg v ^ ) . Since the experiment is complete at the time when the analysis is performed, X^, the matrix of ligand concentrations, can be assumed to be constant so that y is a function of p, the values of the kinetic constants, alone.

626

The object of the strategy may then be stated as to find numerical values of these constants so that a good fit is obtained. A fit is intuitively considered as good, if, in a certain sense, its distance from the actually observed data is small. Thus the goodness of fit is introduced as a distance within the space of experimental variables (the sample space). This concept may be stated more rigorously as follows: m =i:

r •) . { wk(Vyk(p) ) }

where w^ is the weight factor of the k-th sample. Thus $ , the goodness of fit criterion, is introduced as the Euclidean distance between predicted fit and weighted data. Again, this criterion is a function of the parameter values, but also of the scale factor w^ the choice of which defines the statistical relevance of the fit criterion (for instance, weighted least squares, 2

maximum likelihood, minimum £ , or minimum error). The estimation of the parameters may now be formulated as a series of distance explorations in the sample space. The leading principle is that a fit is acceptable if the parameter values lead to a small distance between fit and data: (b(p ) ^ . ^^acc ^eim One point P ^ ^ of this family of acceptable points P a c c is the minimum distance point: $(p) = Min ! the estimation of which is carried out by the following iterative algorithm: p

i+l

: = p

i

+

^

(1)

beginning with a guessed starting point and succesively applying a correction vector dp, until the minimum is found: dp : = - M - g

(2)

The correction is taken in the direction of the negative gradient 8

-

( - £ - )

1 =

1(1,

°

of the $ -criterion in the parameter speace. g is estimated by a l:1000-perturbation difference formula.

627 2 M is the metric applied to this space (an n -matrix). Its choice determines the convergence properties of the algorithm. If simply M

=

I

(identity matrix)

the method of steepest descents results, which has usually safe but extremely slow convergence. If, on the other hand M

=

G" 1

where (g2 i —r—r I i, j = l(l)n «Pi 0Pi / a modified Gauss-Newton search is obtained.

(information matrix)

G i s estimated, to accuracy of order $ , by G

«

gT-g

so that the iteration scheme with G~ as matrix will usually not converge as long as is high. Its eventual convergence when $ is low (i. e. in the neighbourhood of p . ) is however very fast. min

j

To combine the advantages of I and of G" as metric, we have followed an idea by MARQUARDT (2) and applied a linear combination of both: M

=

G" 1 +

X • I

1 & O

(3)

which contains the former ones as limiting cases. During the iteration scheme, X is chosen as small as permissible to achieve stable convergence. The algorithm (1), (2), and (3) was programmed in FORTRAN and Algol 60 and showed excellent convergence and numerical behaviour on a number of digital machines. It was applied to data from Phosphorylase b (paper by H. WILL, this symposium), Phosphofructokinase of yeast (presented in a discussion by E. HOFMANN and his group), and of Pyrophosphatase (discussion by T. RAPOPORT). The input is prepared by the biochemist and contains: 1. the specifications of the models proposed (as addressed from a model catalogue or by an algebraic or topological code), 2. a starting point pQ (stating the order of magnitude of

It is guessed by

inspection of the data and need not, as in other programs, be very precise), 3. the data, i. e. ligand concentrations and binding or velocity values.

628

Then the search for P m i n is performed, and usually after 5 to 10 iterations the output from the computer is: 1. a statement whether or not the model and the data did fit together, 2. if so, the best parameter values, followed by 3. a region of statistical variation of each parameter as obtained by a linear expansion of 1 also at buffered [ Mg + + ]. Thus, a clear experimental distinction between given allosteric and non-allosteric models is possible.

Institut für Physiologische und Biologische Chemie der Humboldt-Universität Berlin Physikochemisches Zentrum der Deutschen Akademie der Wissenschaften zu Berlin, Berlin-Buch Physiologisch-Chemisches Institut der Karl-Marx-Universität Leipzig

G. GERBER, I. RA PO PORT, R. HINTSCHE, S. RA PO PORT, H. -J. BÖHME INTERACTION OF IMIDAZOLE WITH MULTIVALENT ANIONS AS MODEL FOR BINDING OF PHOSPHOCOMPOUNDS TO PROTEINS

From investigations on binding of multivalent anions to haemoglobin we deduced a participation of imidazole groups (1,2, 3). Fig. 1 shows a steep decline in the binding of ATP to oxygenated and deoxygenated human haemoglobin by changing the pH from 6 to '8, 5. The binding goes down to zero in the case of oxygenated haemoglobin. If binding of phosphocompounds to haemoglobin would be accomplished by electrostatic forces only other positively charged groups besides the imidazole should also be implicated and binding ought to be expected above pH 8,5. In Fig. 2 the influence of temperature on binding of ATP to methaemoglobin is shown on a Scatchard plot. Elevation of temperature decreases the binding. The thermodynamic parameters were reckoned from these and other data (3) not given here and they a r e summarized in the Table 1. The enthalpy of binding (presented in the column on the right) amounts to about -6, 8 kcal/mole. This value corresponds well with -6 to -8 kcal/mole given by WYMAN for the ionization enthalpy of the imidazole group (4). To check wether the binding is restricted to phosphocompounds or wether anions in general will be bound methaemoglobin was titrated with several acids (Fig. 3). The curve on the right represents titration of haemoglobin with hydrochloric acid between pH 9 and 5. With the other acids quite different curves were obtained. That indicates an interaction of the anions added during titration with the haemoglobin. Binding of anions to proteins is accompanied by proton binding. The greater the charge of the anion added in this titrations the more the curves a r e shifted towards the alkaline range. The most pronounced effect has the fourfold negatively charged ferrocyanide. There is a maximal shift of the titration curves between pH 6 and 6, 5. pH-static experiments have been done, too, and they confirm this

632 Table 1 THERMODYNAMIC DATA OF THE ATP BINDING TO METHAEMOGLOBIN

pH

6.2

7.2

1)

T °C 5 10 14 21 5 17

102xK

n

i M" 1 2.10 10

4

G

S

kcal/mole

cal x mole ^ x deg.

-2.94 -2. 89

-13.7

1. 08

-2.84 -2.71

-13.6 -13.7

2. 70

-3.08

-13.6

1. 59

-2.67

-14.4

1.78 1.47

H



-

-Î3.6

kcal/mole -5.10 -7. 88

-6. 75

-7. 35

-6. 85

-6. 85

Mean value

finding (5). Binding to haemoglobin is, therefore, not restricted to phosphocompounds, but it is worth for anions commonly. In view of these evidences on the role of imidazole residues in binding of multivalent anions to haemoglobin we performed model studies with imidazole, histidine and ferrocyanide. Since ferrocyanide is completely dissociated above pH 5, 5 no difficulties owing to changes in its protonation arise in interpretation of experiments with imidazole between pH 6 and 9. Fig. 4 shows the influence of ferrocyanide on the titration of the amino and imidazole group of histidine. Histidine was 10 mM; ferrocyanide 10 mM. In order to check the influence of ionic strength titrations were also carried out with 100 mM sodium chloride. The shift of pK' estimated according to the DEBYEHUCKEL approximation amountsto 0,11. The change of pK' by sodium chloride amounts to 0,15 for the amino group and 0,10 for the imidazole group and it fits well with the theory within experimental uncertainties. Ferrocyanide influences the titration of the amino group in the manner expected from its effect on the ionic strength. But there occurs an additional shift in pK' of the imidazole moiety which is significant. It indicates a somewhat specific interaction between imidazolium and ferrocyanide. The association constant

633 was calculated from this additional shift according to TANFORD (6) and amounts 44 M~ . For this computation a 1:1 interaction was assumed. With imidazole alone quite similar results were obtained and the association constant was calculated to 51 M" 1 . Interaction of ferrocyanide and imidazole causes diminution of the number of osmotically active particles in solution. It ought to be possible, therefore, to draw the number of interacting molecules from the difference of the osmotic activity of an imidazole-ferrocyanide solution and an appropriate solution of identical concentrations. The results of such a study a r e presented in Fig. 5. The values a r e plotted like Scatchard's method for binding of small molecules to macromolecules (7). The intercept on the abscisse indicates formation of an 1:1 complex of imidazole and ferrocyanide. From the slope of the curve an association constant of 31 was determined. That corresponds fairly well with the value found by the titrimetric assay. We tried to investigate this interaction by calorimetric measurements and to calculate the association constant with the method given by BJURULF et al. (8). The heat of dilution of ferrocyanide is very great compared to the heat of association of imidazole with ferrocyanide. One can, however, roughly estimate an association constant below 200 M * . The difference spectrum for imidazole-ferrocyanide was investigated with the double-beam Cary-14 recording spectrophotometer using slit compartment cells (Fig. 6). A broad absorption band with a maximum at 236 nm was observed. There could not be detected such a difference spectrum with potassium chloride of identical ionic strength. SHINITZKI et al. have pointed out (9,10) that the protonated imidazole may act a s electron acceptor in electron donoracceptor complexes. Studies with iodide and indole revealed an absorption band at about 230 and 240 nm respectively for the complexes of imidazolium with these electron donors. The difference spectrum for imidazolium and a multivalent anion presented here would formally well correspond with SHINITZKI' s observations. Nuclear magnetic resonance studies were performed to aquire more information on this type of interaction. Concentrations of imidazole and ferrocyanide were varied between 20 and 100 mM. In the case of sodium chloride a s well a s in that of ferrocyanide there was a shift of the C(2) -proton by 13 to 14 cycles per second and of the C(4) - and C(5) -proton by 6 to 7 cycles per second. This shift

634

of the imidazole protons identically for chloride and ferrocyanide seems to be primarely different from the results of the other investigations. The descrepancies remain to be further clarified. The interaction of imidazolium with multivalent anions presented here seems to be of biological importance. The binding of phosphocompounds to the class of low-affinity binding sites of haemoglobin has an association constant of about 2

-1

10 M (3) which is close to the association constant of the interaction of imidazole and ferrocyanide reported here. An association constant about 100 times higher was found in preliminary measurements on interaction of imidazole and ferrocyanide in dimethyl-sulphoxide. This may to some extent simulate imidazole groups in a hydrophobic surrounding of proteins. In quite a lot of enzymes including phototransferases imidazole seems to play an important role in the binding of the substrates and effectors and in the catalytic reactions. Many of these substrates, cofactors and effectors are anions, especially phosphocompounds and so the interaction with the imidazolium presented might be of significance, especially in a hydrophobic surrounding.

REFERENCES (1) (2)

GARBY, L . , G. GERBER, C. -H. de VERDIER, European J . Biochem. 10, (1969), 110 JUNG, F . , V p 1 International Symposium on Structure and Function of Erythrocytes, Berlin 1970

(3)

JANIG, G. -R., G. GERBER, K. RUCKPAUL, S. RAPOPORT, F. JUNG, European J . Biochem. 17, (1970), 441

(4) (5)

WYMAN, J . , J . Biol. Chem. 127, (1939), 1 RAPOPORT, S . , G. GERBER, K. RUCKPAUL, G.-R. JANIG, F. JUNG, H. FRUNDER, ALFRED-BENZON-Symposium IV: Oxygen Affinity of Hemoglobin and Red Cell Acid-Base Status, Copenhagen 1971

(6) (7)

TANFORD, Ch., Adv. Protein Chem. 1/7, (1962), 127 SCATCHARD, G., Ann. N. Y. Acad. Sci. 51, (1949), 660

(8)

BJURULF, C., J . LAYNEZ, I. WADSC, European J . Biochem. 14, (1970), 47

(9)

SHENITZKY, M., E. KATCHALSKI, V. GRISARO, N. SHARON, Arch. Biochem. Biophys. 116, (1966), 332

(10) MAUCHAMP, J . , M. SHINITZKY, Biochemistry 8, (1969), 1554

635

Fig. 1. Binding of ATP to deoxygenated (o) and oxygenated (o) haemoglobin as a function of pH. Hb: 3,1 mM; ATP: 1, 0 mM; Mg: 3, 0 mM; HC1: 110 mM; NaCl: 20 mM; inorganic phosphate: 1 mM.

Fig. 2. Binding of ATP to methaemoglobin at pH 7, 2 (Scatchardplot). ATP concentration was varied at different temperatures. Hb: 1, 55 mM; KC1: 0,1 M; temperature: 5°, 17°.

636

Fig. 3. Titration of methaemoglobin with acids. Hb: 1, 34 mM; Vol.: 15 ml, temperature: 20 °C.

.3

h i ?

.1

K

9

a

7

S

5

PH

Fig. 4. Effect of anions on the titration of histidine. hfetidine 10 mM; potassium ferrocyanide 10 mM; sodium chloride 100 mM; volume: 20 ml; temperature 25 °C.

637

Fig. 5. Osmometric measurement of the imidazolium-ferrocyanide interaction. 0,1 ml sample contained: 4 ¿u moles K4 Fe(CN)g, 4 to 40,umoles imidazole, 2 to 20,umoles HC1 (pH 6, 8). 0,1 ml reference solution contained 1 to lO^imoles NaCl (pH 9, 2) instead of HC1.

Fig. 6. Difference spectrum of the imidazolium-ferrocyanide interaction. Imidazole: 0,1 M; potassium ferrocyanide 10"^ M. Cary-14 spectrophotometer, 10 mm slit-compartment cells, temperature: 20 °C.

Institute of Biochemistry, Hungarian Academy of Sciences, Budapest

L. POLGAR, P. HALASZ ENHANCED REACTIVITY OF THE SH GROUP OF THIOL-SUBTILISIN

Thiol-enzymes, like papain or glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase, have an SH group at their active site which is much more reactive than simple thiol-compounds. The origin of this enhanced reactivity has been studied in many laboratories, still we do not know the exact mechanism which would account for the reactivity of the SH group of thiol enzymes. In the present talk, I am going to deal with the reactivity of an artificial cysteine enzyme, thiol subtilisin, which can be prepared from the serine protease, Carlsberg type subtilisin, by replacing the OH-group of its reactive serine residue with an SH-group (1). The reason for choosingthiol-subtilisin for such a study resides in the fact that we know the mechanism of action ox the parent serine protease in considerable detail. Fig. 1 shows the basic features of the mechanism of action of serine proteoses. Serine proteases catalyze the hydrolysis of ester or amide substrates through the formation of an intermediate acyl-enzyme. A particular serine residue a s a nucleophile and one histidine residue a s a general base, general acid catalyst participate in the formation of the acyl-enzyme. The hydrolysis of the acyl-enzyme proceeds through the reverse mechanism. In the hydrolysis, the hydroxyl group of a water-molecule is the nucleophile rather than the hydroxyl group of the serine residue. Thiol-subtilisin is an ineffective enzyme towards the specific substrates of subtilisin, nevertheless it catalyzes the hydrolysis of some non-specific substrates through the acyl-enzyme intermediate a s the original serine enzyme. Our previous studies have indicated that in the hydrolysis of p-nitrophenyl acetate catalyzed by thiol-subtilisin, the histidine residue in the proximity of the SHgroup participates both in the formation and decomposition of the acetylthiolenzyme intermediate (2). On the other hand, NEET et al. have suggested that the reactivity of the SH-group of thiol-subtilisin towards iodoacetamide is similar to that of a simple thiol-compound (3). Of course, the chemical mechanism of

640 acyl-enzyme formation, which proceeds through the formation of a tetrahedral intermediate, is significantly different from that of alkylation, which is a simple 3 nucleophilic subtitution on the sp carbon atom. However, if the histidine residue contributes to the reactivity of the SH-group of thiol-subtilisin, this participation of the imidazole ring should manifest itself not only in acylation but also in alkylation. Therefore, we have studied the reaction of thiol-subtilisin with iodoacetamide in a wide pH-interval where the participation of the histidine residue in alkylation may be demonstrated. Fig. 2 shows the pH-dependence of the second order rate constants of alkylation of thiol-subtilisin and glutathione with iodoacetamide in a semilogarithmic plot. The rate constants were measured in the presence of 1 M potassium chloride under second-order conditions or with excess iodoacetamide under pseudo first order conditions. The reaction followed the given reaction order for about 2-3 half lives. The solid lines in the figure are theoretical curves corresponding to the dissociation of one ionizable group. The pK of this ionizable group is 10 in the case of the enzyme and 9 in the case of glutathione which can be regarded a s a model compound of a protein containing a simple thiol group. It is seen from the figure that the experimental points in the alkaline pH-range fit well to the theoretical curve indicating that the reation of the enzyme, similarly to the reaction of the glutathione, depends on the dissociation of the SH-group. The pK of the enzyme is one unit higher than that of glutathione, and the second-order rate constants of the enzyme containing the fully dissociated SH-group a r e in the same order of magnitude. This is a fairly good agreement when an enzyme and a model compound are compared. On the other hand, around neutral pH the experimental points do not follow the theoretical curve calculated for the ionizable group with the pK of 10. The rate constants a r e independent of pH in the range of 6 to 8. As the pH decreases, the rate of alkylation of the enzyme becomes increasingly higher relative to that of glutathione. Thus, at pH 7 there is a 300-fold and at pH 6 a 3000 fold difference in the rate constants. At even lower pH values this differenceis still higher but it is difficult to obtain exact values for the rate constants because of the denaturation of the protein. The considerable rate-enhancement of the reaction at lower pH values should be due to the participation of the histidine residue. One of the possible forms of this participation would be a general base catalysis by the imidazole ring. However, the pH-dependence of alkylation does not support this possibility.

641

Namely, a pK of about 7 characteristic of the imidazole base is not seen in the pH -dependence curve, although it would be e j e c t e d if a simple general base catalysis were to operate, as it was found in the case of the parent serine protease. Another reasonable explanation which can account for the pH-dependence of alkylation is the formation of a hydrogen bond between the imidazole and the SH -groups. In this case, the apparent pK of the histidine residue should be shifted to lower values and that of the SH-group to higher values with a few pH units. In contrast to acylation by p-nitrophenyl acetate, alkylation by iodoacetamide clearly shows the pK of the SH-group of thiol-subtilisin, and this is only slightly higher than the pK of an ordinary SH-group. Accordingly, only a weak hydrogen bond, if any, can be formed between the imidazole and the SH-groups. It appeared that the nature of the interaction between histidine and cysteine residues could be determined by the DgO effect on the rate constants. A D^O effect of about 3 would occur in the pH-range of 6 to 8 if a general base catalysis were to operate by the histidine residue (4). This value may be lower if a hydrogen bond is formed between the imidazole and the SH-groups. According to our measurements the ratio of the second-order rate constants of alkylation in water and in D2O is 0. 95 + 0.15 rather than 3. This rules out the possibility of general base catalysis, and does not indicate that a significant hydrogen bqnd between the imidazole and the SH-groups would exist. In order to explain the enhancement of the reactivity of the thiol-enzyme, we have to introduce the idea of cage pair or intimate pair formation in enzymes as a possible and important factor of catalytic function. This idea is applied in physical chemistry when molecules separated by the solvent and intimate pairs inside a common solvent shell are distinguished. Of course, intimate pairs of single molecules are very unstable in solution, since the two members of the pair react with each other or separate instantaneously. In a protein, however, the tertiary structure may be sufficiently rigid to hold two functional groups in the cage in which the separation by solvent is not possible. Now we would interpret the reaction between thiol-subtilisin and iodoacetamide as follows. The reactivity of the SH-group above pH 9 corresponds to that of an ordinary thiol-compound. In the pH range of 6 to 8, the participation of a histidine residue accounts for the enhancement of the reactivity. The imidazole and the thiol groups form an intimate pair in which the proton is covalently bound to the nitrogen atom of the ring. Thus the intimate pair consists of a positive

642

imidazolium ion and a negative mercaptide ion. If a weak hydrogen bond existed between these two groups, the donor atom should be the nitrogen and the acceptor should be the sulfur atom. The lower reactivity of the mercaptide ion in the cage pair compared to the free mercaptide ion may be due to the effect of the positive charge of the imidazolium ion. Finally, we would like to note that similar mechanism may account for the enhanced reactivity of the thiol group of creatine phosphotransferase and perhaps other thiol enzymes, too. In addition, intimate pair formation is not restricted to thiol and imidazole groups. This may be i general phenomenon which can significantly contribute to the catalytic power of enzymes.

REFERENCES (1) (2)

POLGAR, L . , Acta Biochim. et.Biophys. Acad. Sci. Hung. 3, (1969), 397 POLGAR, L . , M.L. BENDER, Biochemistry 6, (1967), 610

(3)

NEET, K.E., A. NANCI, D. E. KOSHLAND J r . , J.Biol.Chem. 243, (1968), 6392

(4)

BENDER, M. L . , F . J . KEZDY, Ann. Rev. Biochem. 34, (1965), 49

643 Acy/af/on

r-Im

H 0 +

OR' I C—R

|-ImH+ OR' I 0—R—R'

r-Im

HOR' /

ir

0—C—R I 0

Deacyhtion

Fig. 1. Mechanisms of action of serine proteases.

6

7

8

pH

9

10 71

Fig. 2. pH-dependence of the second-order rate constants of alkylation with iodoacetamide. o-o: thiol-subtilisin, x-x: glutathione.

Institut für medizinische Chemie der Universität Wien

E. GRÜNDIG, R . F . L . MARUNA URSPRUNG UND EIGENSCHAFTEN VON ISOZYMEN DER PHOSPHOMONOESTERASEN

In der medizinischen Literatur werden 2 Gruppen von Phosphomonoesterasen des Blutserums bzw. Plasmas beschrieben, die als saure und alkalische Phosphatasen bezeichnet werden. Diese Enzyme kommen ubiquitär vor. Im Hinblick auf die Beurteilung des Aussagewertes von Phosphatasebestimmungen im klinischen Laboratorium wäre es interessant zu wissen, welchen Ursprung diese Plasmaenzyme haben, falls sie im Serum in erhöhter Aktivität vorliegen. Zur Charakterisierung dieser Enzyme haben wir folgende Bestimmungen eingeführt: Messung der Substrat Spezifität gegen Phenylphosphat, Nitrophenylphosphat, - und ß-Glycerophosphat, Bestimmung der pH-Optima, Beeinflussung der Aktivität durch Cu ++ , Formaldehyd, F ' , ÄDTA, L-Tartrat und Cystein und elektrophoretische Auftrennung im Dünnschicht-Stärkegel. Als Puffer diente zur Aktivitätsbestimmung grundsätzlich Azetat- oder Veronalpuffer, zur Elektrophorese 0, 02 M Trisazetat oder Carbonatpuffer. Als Substrat wurde - wenn nicht anders angegeben - Na-Phenylphosphat verwendet. Nach der Elektrophorese im Stärkegelstreifen (20 x 3 cm) von 2 mm Dicke werden diese mit einem mit Substrat-Puffer-Gemisch getränkten, sehr saugfähigen Filterpapierstreifen bedeckt - die Kapazität des Puffers ist so groß, daß die Kombination Gel-Papier den gewünschten pH-Wert 4, 8 oder 9, 5 erreicht. Nach etwa 1 stündiger Inkubation bei 37 °C werden die Papier streifen mit Phosphorwolfram säure versetzt. Das freigesetzte Phenol bewirkt die Umsetzung zu Wolfraumblau, das mit Ammoniakdämpfen in Form blauer Zonen sichtbar gemacht wird. Gegenfärbung der Gelstreifen zeigt, daß darin kein freies Phenol enthalten ist. Die Streifen werden densitometrisch ausgewertet, die Färbung ist im gewählten Bereich der Enzymaktivität proportional. Zuerst sollen Versuche an Rattengeweben besprochen werden, an denen die Brauchbarkeit der Analysenmethodik und der Aussagewert der Ergebnisse getestet wurden. Die Extraktion der Organe erfolgte imm er durch Homogenisieren

646 im Pottergerät mit Teflonstab mit 0, 9 %iger Kochsalzlösung bei + 4° und anschließendem Zentrifugieren bei 7000 x g. Es war dies das schonendste Vorgehen, wir erhielten die höchstmöglichen Gesamtaktivitäten; letztere konnten durch Beschallung nicht erhöht werden. Abb. 1 gibt nun schematisch die Lokalisierung und Bezeichnung der Isozymfraktionen auf den Pherogrammen in bezug auf Serumproteine wieder. Die Streckenlänge bezeichnet die Streuungsbreite der Bandenmittelpunkte bei den durchgeführten Bestimmungen. Die an der Auftragsstelle verbleibende Fraktion nennen wir 0, die bei pH 8, 6 anodisch wandernden A^-Ag, die kathodisch wandernden Kj-Kg. Der Nullfraktion entsprechen im Serum die Globuline (IgM), der Fraktion Ag die Albumine, kathodisch wandernde Proteinfraktionen sind im Serum unter den gewählten Bedingungen die ^ Globuline (IgG). Abb. 2 zeigt am Beispiel von Rattennierenextrakten, daß wir bis zu 10 Fraktionen von sauren Phosphatasen erhalten haben. Aus dem Pherogramm geht hervor, daß die Gewebsextrakte nicht aufbewahrt werden dürfen. Die Beweglichkeit der Enzymproteine ändert sich. Es erfolgt eine Anreicherung an der Auftragsstelle und die mit den Präalbuminen wandernden Fraktionen und Ag akkumulieren in der Albuminbande. Aus Abb. 3, der Isozymverteilung von Rattenmuskelextrakten, ist zu entnehmen, daß sich auch beim Einfrieren und Wiederauftauen Veränderungen in der Verteilung der Fraktionen ergeben. Diese sind bei den 8-9 Fraktionen der sauren Phosphatasen nicht sehr stark - am auffallendsten ist der Befund, daß die Fraktion Ag verschwindet. Bei den alkalischen Phosphatasen verschwinden die kathodisch wandernden und die mittleren Fraktionen A^-A^, es erfolgt Anreicherung an der Auftragsstelle und im Albuminbereich. Des weiteren interessierte uns, ob Proteinkonzentration und Phosphataseaktivität der einzelnen Fraktionen parallel sind. Abb. 4 zeigt das Ergebnis der Untersuchungen am Beispiel der Rattenmilz. Kathodisch wandernde Proteine lagen in so niedriger Konzentration vor, daß sie mit den üblichen Färbemethoden (Amidoschwarz) nicht mehr nachweisbar waren, Phosphataseaktivitäten waren jedoch einwandfrei vorhanden. Während die Phosphataseaktivitäten an der Auftrags st eile am höchsten waren, lagen am Ort der höchsten Proteinkonzentration mit der Wanderungsgeschwindigkeit der Serum albumine (Ag) nur geringe Aktivitäten vor. Die nächste Abb. Nr. 5 zeigt am Beispiel des Oberschenkelknochens der Ratte, wie sehr die Isozymmuster innerhalb eines Gewebes verschieden und wie empfind-

647 lieh die Phosphatasen gegenüber äußeren Einflüssen sind. Wird der ganze Knochen schnell homogenisiert und zentrifugiert, findet man kathodisch wandernde Fraktionen. Schon durch den Zeitaufwand der weiteren Aufbereitung des Knochens - Zerteilen, Ausspülen des Markes etc. treten die ersten Veränderungen ein - die kathodisch wandernden Fraktionen sind nicht mehr nachweisbar. Vergleicht man Epiphyse und Diaphyse, ergibt sich, daß bei ersterer bei den sauren Phosphatasen die Aktivität der Fraktion 0 niedriger ist als bei den letzteren, während in der Fraktion A g die Aktivität in der Epiphyse höher ist als in der Diaphyse. Bei den alkalischen Phosphatasen sind die relativen Differenzen nicht so groß. Vom Knochenmark haben wir 2 Aufbereitungen gemacht: bei einer wurde das Mark lediglich aus dem Knochen herausgespült und zentrifugiert (Eluat), bei der anderen der Rückstand des "Eluates" noch in der üblichen Weise homogenisiert und dann zentrifugiert ("Homogenat"). Bei den sauren Phosphatasen sieht man hervorstechende Unterschiede in der Isozymverteilung: Im "Eluat" sind die Fraktionen Ag, A^ und Ag höher, im Homogenat die Fraktionen A 2 und A^. Bei den alkalischen Phosphatasen ist im "Eluat" die Aktivität der Fraktion 0 mit 53 % die weitaus höchste, im "Homogenat" überwiegen die Fraktionen und A^. Diese Unterschiede sind ein deutlicher Hinweis auf die verschiedene Lokalisation der einzelnen Isozymfraktionen innerhalb der Zelle.

Table 1 PROTEIN CONTENT AND TOTAL ACTIVITY OF ACID AND ALKALINE PHOSPHATASES IN TISSUE EXTRACTS OF HIGH-BONE (RAT) APPLIED FOR INVESTIGATIONS content of proteins

Total bone Epiphysis Diaphysis "Eluate" Marrow "Homogenate"

Activity of acid phosphatases alkaline phosphatases

0,42 0, 32 0, 04 0,42

190 mg/Phenol/g/h 146 12

28

650

3940

0,42

560

5950

1940 mg Phenol/g/h 145

648 Die Tabelle 1 gibt Proteingehalt und Gesamtaktivität der sauren und alkalischen Phosphatasen in den zur Isozymtrennung verwendeten Knochenextrakten an. Mit Ausnahme des Diaphysenextraktes waren Proteingehalt und Aktivität der sauren Phosphatasen in der gleichen Größenordnung. Bei den alkalischen Phosphatasen fällt auf, daß praktisch die gesamte Aktivität im Knochenmark enthalten war. Die Tabelle 2 gibt abschließend einen vergleichenden Überblick über Verteilung der Phosphataseisozyme in einigen Gewebsarten der Ratte. Angegeben sind die Zahl der aufgefundenen Fraktionen sowie die Fraktionen mit der höchsten relativen Aktivität. Im Muskelextrakt fanden wir je 9 Fraktionen, im Milzextrakt je 8 der sauren und alkalischen Phosphatasen mit der höchsten Aktivität jeweils an der

Table 2 SUMMARY: DISTRIBUTION OF PHOSPHATASE ISOZYMES IN SOME RATTISSUES Acid phosphatases Number of Highest activity

Number of Highest activity

Name of the rei % fractions

Name of the rei % fractions 9

0

26,4

51,0

8

0

26,5

20,6

10

0

26,6

9

0

23,4

Spleen

8

0

Kidney

10

0 A 7/8

22,6

Muscle

Bone total "Eluate"

12

3 K 2/3

A

14,0

10

A

1

A

3

0

17,6

37, 6 21,9

7

0

53,2

A 6/7

38,5

7

0

34,5

0

24,4

7

A 6/7

21,6

A

9 9

3

2 0

A

Diaphysis

21, 0

23,5

8

Marrow "Hömogenate"

Alkaline phosphatases

A

2

21,9 28,0 10,2

649 Auftragsstelle. Im Nierenextrakt lagen je 10 Fraktionen vor mit hoher Aktivität an der Auftragsstelle. Bei den sauren Phosphatasen wandern etwa 23 % mit den Präalbuminen (A 7 , g), bei den alkalischen bleiben weitere 21 % im Bereich der -Globuline (A^). Im ganzen Knochen finden wir 12 bzw. 10-Fraktionen, besonders hohe Aktivitäten im Bereich der A g -Fraktion: bei den sauren Phosphatasen finden wir zusätzlich hohe Aktivitäten, die kathodisch wandern, bei den alkalischen an der Auftragsstelle. Der Aussagewert dieses Befundes ist nur gering, wenn man sich an die Aktivitätsverteilung (Tab. 1) erinnert. Besonders soll nochmals auf das unterschiedliche Isozymmuster in unseren Markpräparaten hingewiesen werden: Bei den sauren Phosphatasen im "Eluat" höchste Aktivität in der AgFraktion, im "Homogenat" in den Fraktionen Ag und A^, während bei den alkalischen Phosphatasen in beiden Präparationen die Hauptmenge der Aktivität an der Auftragsstelle liegen bleibt. An zwei Beispielen soll noch kurz die Wirkung von Effektoren auf unsere Gewebeextrakte aufgezeigt werden.

Table 3 THE INFLUENCE OF EFFECTORS ON THE ACTIVITY OF ACID PHOSPHATASES IN RAT-KIDNEY MEASURED AT THE 3 pH-OPTIMA (SUBSTRATE: PHENYL PHOSPHATE) pH 4 , 0

pH 5, 0

pH 6,4

10" 4 m CuS0 4

- 38%

- 60 %

- 84 %

10" m NaF

-28%

- 33 %

- 19%

0, 5 % HCHO -2 10 m L-Tartrate

- 19%

- 52 %

- 92 %

- 33 %

4

2. 5 . 1 0 " 3 m EDTA 2. 5 . 1 0 " 5 m EDTA

- 44 %

+ 83 %

+ 116 %

+ 260 %

+ 20%

+

+ 100 %

20%

Tabelle 3 illustriert den Einfluß auf die Aktivität von sauren Phosphatasen aus Rattennieren bei den 3 pH-Optima, bei pH 4, 0, pH 5, 0 und pH 6,4, wenn als Substrat Phenylphosphat eingesetzt wird. Cu + + , F ' und Formaldehyd wirken als Inhibitoren. Besonders ist darauf hinzuweisen, daß L-Tartrat speziell bei nie-

650 drigen pH-Werten stark hemmt. Dieser Befund ist im Hinblick auf die Annahme vieler Kliniker äußerst wichtig, daß man im Serum Prostataphosphatasen selektiv durch ihre Hemmbarkeit durch L-Tartrat nachweisen könne. Durch EDTA sind saure Nierenphosphatasen stark aktivierbar. Auch saure Milzpho sphata sen haben 3 pH-Optima (pH 4, 0, pH 5, 0 und pH 5, 5) (Tabelle 4).

Table 4 THE INFLUENCE OF EFFECTORS ON THE ACTIVITY OF ACID PHOSPHATASES IN RAT-SPLEEN (pH-OPTIMA: 4, 0 - 5, 0 - 5, 5 - SUBSTRATE: PHENYLPHOSPHAT) pH 4, 0

pH 5,2

10 m CuSO,4 _4 10 m NaF

-46%

-71% -43%

0, 5 % HCHO -2 10 m L-Tartrate

-34%

4

2. 5.10" 3 m EDTA

- 58% - 18%

- 53 % -43%

+ 36 %

- 19%

Gegen Cu ++ , F' und Formaldehyd verhalten sie sich ähnlich wie Nierenphosphatasen, sind aber durch EDTA weniger aktivierbar und sehr viel weniger tartratempfindlich. Diese Beispiele zeigen, daß auch die Empfindlichkeit gegen Effektoren als Unterscheidungsmerkmal dienen kann. Im folgenden soll nun kurz über die Anwendung der geschilderten Erkenntnisse auf Fragestellungen der Humanmedizin eingegangen werden. Zunächst einige Befunde bei M. Gaucher. Dabei handelt es sich um eine in Mitteleuropa selten auftretende Erbkrankheit, u. a. gekennzeichnet durch Speicherung des Pipoids Kerasin im rediculoendothelialen System; Speicherzellen sind vor allem in Knochenmarks- und Organpunktat - oft, aber nicht immer, tritt ein Milztumor auf. Der Nachweis der Speicherzellen ist schwierig, so daß eine weitere diagnostische Möglichkeit gesucht wurde. Da die Aktivitäten der sauren Serumphosphatasen stets erhöht waren, wurde ihre Charakterisierung versucht. Abb. 6 zeigt, daß die Isozymverteilung im Plasma stark von der Norm abweicht.

651 Sie entspricht aber praktisch der Verteilung im Milzhomogenat, das viele Speicherzellen enthielt. Diese Untersuchungen wurden noch mit der Stärkeblockelektrophorese nach Smithies durchgeführt, die quantitative Aussagen nicht ohne weiteres zuläßt und weniger Fraktionen ergibt. Die Piasmaphosphatasen sind, wie aus der Tabelle 5 hervorgeht, bei den beiden pH-Optima 3, 85 und 5,1 durch Cu + + und Formaldehyd wenig, durch F ' stark hemmbar, werden durch EDTA kaum beeinflußt und wie die Phosphatasen aus Milzhomogenat durch Cystein aktiviert.

Table 5 THE INFLUENCE OF EFFECTORS ON THE ACTIVITY OF ACID PHOSPHATASES IN PLASMA AND SPLEEN-HOMOGENATE OF PATIENTS SUFFERING FROM M. GAUCHER (SUBSTRATE: PHENYLPHOSPHATE, FOR ESTIMATIONS WITH CYSTEINE: ß -GLYCEROPHOSPHATE)

Plasma: 10 10

_4 .4

m CuSO.4 m NaF

pH 3, 85

pH 5 , 1

-

4%

- 37 %

- 77 %

- 70%

0, 5 % HCHG

-

- 33 %

2. 5. 10" m EDTA -4 10 m Cystein

+ 6% + 42 %

+ 10%

+ 40%

+ 25 %

3

+ 70%

Spleen -homogenate: 10

m Cystein

Durch die Summe dieser Merkmale unterscheiden sie sich deutlich von Phosphotasen, die bei anderen Erkrankungen im Plasma - meist mit erhöhter Aktivität auftreten. Einschlägige Untersuchungen wurden bereits mit Erfolg differentialdiagnostisch eingesetzt. Als weiteres Beispiel möchten wir die wichtigsten Befunde bei primärem Hyperparathyreoidismus mitteilen, der zu einer generalisierten Erkrankung des Knochengerüstes führt. Die Serumphosphatasen sind erhöht. Tabelle 6 gibt einen Überblick über die Verteilung der Phosphataseisozyme in Epithelkörperchen (Autopsiematerial) und exstirpierten Parathyreoideaadenomen. Elektrophoretisch treten je 9 Fraktionen von sauren und je 8 von alkalischen

652

Table 6 SUMMARY: DISTRIBUTION OF PHOSPHATASE ISOZYMES IN PARATHYREOIDEA AND PARATHYREOIDEA-ADENOMA Acid phosphatases Number of fractions

Alkaline phosphatases

Highest activity Name of rei % the fraction

Number of fractions

Highest activity Name of rei % the fraction

Parathyreoidea

9

0 A 2/3

32,2 21,8

8

0 A 2/3

44,0 24,0

Adenoma

9

0 A 2/3

35,2 21,5

8

K 1/2 0 A 2/3

17,0 18,0

Phosphatasen auf. Die Isozymverteilung ist bei den sauren Phosphatasen in beiden Präparaten praktisch identisch, unterscheidet sich aber stark bei den alkalischen Phosphatasen. Hier liegt die Hauptaktivität bei den Epithelkörperchen im Bereich der Auftragsstelle sowie in den Fraktionen Ag und Ag, bei den Adenomen ist außerdem ein hoher Prozentsatz kathodisch wandernder Anteile zu sehen. Es wurden nun bei 5 Patienten (Tabelle 7) die Phosphataseaktivitäten im Plasma vor der Operation und 2 Tage nach Entfernung der Adenome untersucht. Die Aktivitäten der sauren Phosphatasen waren vor der Operation erhöht, hatten aber sofort nach der Operation praktisch Normalwerte erreicht. Die erhöhten Aktivitäten der alkalischen Phosphatasen blieben hoch; nach 12 Tagen erreichten sie bei einem Patienten (geringe Knochenaffektionen) sehr niedrige Werte. Daher vermuten wir, daß die im Plasma in erhöhter Aktivität auftretenden sauren Phosphatasen aus den Adenomen stammen könnten. Die Vermutung wird durch den in Abb. 14 dargestellten Einfluß von Effektoren auf die sauren Phosphatasen in Adenom ext rakt, Epitelkörperchen und Patientenplasma untermauert. Soweit die Messungen durchgeführt werden konnten, stimmen die Ergebnisse über ein: Hemmbarkeit durch Cu ++ , F ' , Formaldehyd und Tartrat, Aktivierbarkeit durch EDTA. Diese Phosphatasen sind also zum Unterschied von den bei M. Gaucher auftretenden durch EDTA aktivierbar. Die durch Elektrophorese

653 Table 7 ACTIVITIES OF PHOSPHATASE IN PLASMA OF PATIENTS SUFFERING FROM PRIMARY HYPERPARATHYREOIDISM B E F O R E RESECTION (A. O. ) AND ON THE 2 n d DAY AFTERWARDS (P.O. ) IN mU/ml (SUBSTRAT: NITROPHENYLPHOSPHATE)

Patient Nr.

Acid phosphatases

1 2

Alkaline phosphatases

A.O.

P.O.

A.O.

P.O.

26,6

13,3

400

384

6,0

5,0

83

60

22,4

5,0

23

24

4

28,3

15,0

116

110

5

17,1

10, 9

139

130

Standard

till 11 mU/ml

3

1

1

20 - 48 mU/ml

12 days after resection: alkaline phosphatases 3, 0 mU/ml

Table 8 THE INFLUENCE OF EFFECTORS ON THE ACTIVITY OF ACID PHOSPHATASES IN PARATHYREOIDEA ADENOMA AND IN PLASMA OF PATIENTS SUFFERING FROM PRIMARY HYPERPARATHYREOIDISM COMPARED WITH NORMAL PARATHYREOIDEA

Plasma

Adenoma -extract

Parathyreoidea-extract

pH4,4

pH 5 , 2

pH4,4

pH 5 , 1

pH 4 , 4

m CuSO.

-

75%

-

39%

_

-

7%

_

m NaF

-

25%

-

61%

- 21 %

-

9%

-

90%

-

58%

- 10%

- 17%

10" m L-Tartrate

-

25%

2. 5 . 1 0 " 3 m EDTA

+ 100%

10 10

4

-4

4

0, 5 % HCHO 2

-

-

- 100%

-

9%

- 33 %

- 63 %

+

+ 42 %

+ 70 %

+ 32 %

43%

654 bewirkte Auftrennung der alkalischen Phosphatasen hingegen entspricht der bei anderen Knochenerkrankungen z. B. M. PAGET (Osteitis deformans) gefundenen, und ist ähnlich der des unfraktionierten Knochens und des "Homogenates" aus Knochenmark. Zum Schluß danken wir Dr. CZITOBER, unserem ärztlichen Mitarbeiter von der 1. Medizinischen Universitätsklinik Wien, der uns das Material für die Untersuchungen an Humanpräparaten zur Verfügung stellte.

655 Origin Kz

L

Ki

I

JgM

Ay

A2

A3

JgA+G

p

A4

oez

As

Ag

Aj

Ag

7Tb.

oe7

Origin K2

Ki JgG

f^ JgM

A-, JgA

A2 (J

A3

A4

oc2

As

ocj



A^

Alb.

Pre Alb.

A^

Fig. 1. The mobility of the phosphatase fractions in relation to the serum protein fractions. Top: alkaline phosphatases (carbonate buffer); Bottom: acid phosphatases (tris buffer).

40-

K2

KT

&

|

fresh



7 week stored

AJ

AZ

tissue

AS

at+4°C

A4

As

A6

A7

Fig. 2. The isozyme pattern of the acid phosphatases of rat-kidney.

656

30r

I

*

I

¿1



¿2

I

I

M



As

I

A6

A?

| fresh 1 ^ tissue Q froozcn J

Ki,2

d

I .

A;

I .

A2

I

A3

• •

A4

I

A5

I I

Ag

Ay

Fig. 3. The isozyme pattern of rat-muscle phophatases. Top: acid phophatases. Bottom: alkaline phosphatases.

657

|

protein

¡3 acid phosphatases H alkal. phosphatases

t. t. K2

Kj

*

Fig. 4. The protein and phosphatase-isozyme pattern of rat-spleen homogenates.

658

659

TTTTTTT

DD

, Conir. ßd., ,Contr. Plasma

1.1? Od.

Spleen homog.

Fig. 6. The isozyme pattern of acid plasma phosphatases and the related enzymes of spleen homogenate in Gaucher's disease.

Institut für Pharmakologie und Toxikologie der Ernst-Moritz-Arndt-Universität Greifswald

J. BEHLKE, J. LAMPE, W. SCHELER LIGANDENINDUZIERTE ÄNDERUNGEN VON CD-SPEKTREN UND VOM ASSOZIATIONS-DISSOZIATIONS -GLEICHGEWICHT DES NEUNAUGEN-HÄMOGLOBINS

Proteine und speziell Enzyme stellen vielfach assoziierende Systeme dar (1). Unter einem Assoziat verstehen wir ein aus mindestens zwei Untereinheiten bestehendes Makromolekül, in dem die Monomeren durch nichtkovalente Bindungen zusammengehalten werden. Durch Variation der Milieubedingungen (pH, Ionenstärke usw.), aber auch durch Substrat- oder Ligandenbindung, durch Modifizierung der prosthetischen Gruppe oder des Apoproteins können die sog. Zwischenkettenbeziehungen im Makromolekül beeinflußt und konzentrationsabhängige Veränderungen der Molekulargewichte nachgewiesen werden. Als Modell für unsere Untersuchungen wählten wir verschiedene Hb. Sie bestehen meistens aus zwei Arten von Hämpolypeptidketttn gemäß der Formel o^ßg * ü r 2

1 Hb

Wieweit die Assoziation abläuft, hängt jedoch vom gewählten Milieu, dem Oxydationszustand des Eisens und der Ligandenbindung ab. Die Molekulargewichtsbestimmungen am Neunaugen-Hb wurden mit einer analytischen Ultrazentrifuge durchgeführt. Für die CD-Untersuchungen verwendeten wir einen Dichrographen der Fa. Jouan (Typ CD 185).

662 Die Untersuchungen führten zu folgenden Ergebnissen: 1. Molekulargewichtsstudien 1.1. MetHb: Das Flußneunaugen-MetHb mit dem dreiwertigen Eisen als Zentralatom sedimentiert verhältnismäßig langsam. Die Sedimentationskoeffizienten variieren nur geringfügig mit der Konzentration (4, 5) (Abb. 1). Es liegt eine schwach negative Kbnzentrationsabhängigkeit der S^Q ^ - W e r t e vor, s 2 Q w = 1, 94 - 0, 015- c[S] (c = g/100 ml). Mit Hilfe der empirischen Gleichung von ATASSI und GANDHI (6): (4) v '

M = (s - s.) / k *o 1

s = Sedimentationskonstante: o ' s. = 0,68; k = 7,416; 10" 5 läßt sich eine Molmasse von 17 000 bestimmen. Auf Grund der Aminosäureanalyse konnte für das monomere Molekül ein Molekulargewicht von 16 450 ermittelt werden (7). Durch Variation des pHWertes zwischen 4, 5 und 10 wurden keine Veränderungen im Sedimentationsverhalten und somit im Molekulargewicht beobachtet (Abb. 2). Die Ionisation des am Eisen gebundenen HgO -Moleküls mit einem pK' = 8,15 hat somit keinen Einfluß auf die hydrodynamischen Eigenschaften des NeunaugenMetHb. 1.2. MetHb -L -Komplexe In Gegenwart der Liganden Ng~, F~, CN~, OCN" und SCN~ bilden sich die entsprechenden MetHb-L-Komplexe aus. Dabei variieren auf Grund der unterschiedlichen Affinitäten auch die dazu notwendigen Ligandenkonzentrationen. Die Kom plexbildung macht sich nicht im alkalischen pH-Bereich, aber im schwach sauren Milieu im Sedimentationsverhalten bemerkbar (Abb. 2). Die Sedimentationskoeffizienten steigen dabei von 1,9 [ s ] auf 3,1 [S] an. Bereits in geringen Konzentrationen des MetHb- N^ beobachten wir die entsprechende Zunahme der s 20 w ' W e r t e (Abb. 1) und eine Zunahme des Molekulargewichtes auf das Doppelte (Mg = 33 000). Die Reversibilität der Dimerisierung kann entweder durch Verdünnung oder Alkalisieren der Proben mit nachfolgender Dissoziation nachgewiesen werden. Die pH-Abhängigkeit der Sedimentationskoeffizienten gehorcht einem Dimer-Monomer-Übergang unter Mitwirkung eines Protons pro Monomer (5)

2P + 2 H

(PH)2

663 1 (6)

Ka

2 - c-

(1 -oc) [H]

2

Daraus ergibt sich f ü r den Dissoziationsgrad (7)

•a 1 ^ M • I 0 4 6 Proteinconcentration

'A

I 12

L_ 16 [g/ I j

Fig. 1. Sedimentationskoeffizienten des Neunaugen-MetHb (o) bzw. -MetHb- N3 (A) in Abhängigkeit von der MetHb-Konzentration. NaN3-Konzentration 1-5 mM, pH 4, 9-5, 7. Puffer: 0,1 M Acetat (5).

0? 3 i w 2

6

7

10

PH Fig. 2. pH-Abhängigkeit der Sedimentationskoeffizienten vom NeunaugenMetHb (o) und -MetHb-N3 ( • ). MetHb-Konzentration 2-12 g/l . Partiell gefüllte Karos: Unvollständige Assoziation. Die ausgezogene obere Kurve wurde rechnerisch entsprechend Gleichung (7) unter Berücksichtigung eines pK-Wertes = 6,75 (4) ermittelt. R: Reneutralisierte Probe eines MetHb- N3-Ansatzes von pH 5, 68. Puffer: 0,1 M Acetat bzw. 0,13 M BoraxPhosphat (5).

668

jy -2

-/

ApH

0

Fig. 3. Theoretische KurvenVerläufe für einen Monom er-Dimer-Übergang unter Einbeziehung eines Protons/monomere Einheit nach Gleichving (5) - (7) für c = 1, 0 und K^ = 1, 0.

.OV o vi